blob: 7879eef16f71aeba8676a3b3d92380ee7ff12623 [file] [log] [blame]
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001#
Wolfgang Denkb75190d2012-01-19 10:58:21 +01002# (C) Copyright 2000 - 2012
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003# Wolfgang Denk, DENX Software Engineering, wd@denx.de.
4#
5# See file CREDITS for list of people who contributed to this
6# project.
7#
8# This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
9# modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as
10# published by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2 of
11# the License, or (at your option) any later version.
12#
13# This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
14# but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
15# MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
16# GNU General Public License for more details.
17#
18# You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
19# along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
20# Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston,
21# MA 02111-1307 USA
22#
23
24Summary:
25========
26
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +000027This directory contains the source code for U-Boot, a boot loader for
wdenke86e5a02004-10-17 21:12:06 +000028Embedded boards based on PowerPC, ARM, MIPS and several other
29processors, which can be installed in a boot ROM and used to
30initialize and test the hardware or to download and run application
31code.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000032
33The development of U-Boot is closely related to Linux: some parts of
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +000034the source code originate in the Linux source tree, we have some
35header files in common, and special provision has been made to
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000036support booting of Linux images.
37
38Some attention has been paid to make this software easily
39configurable and extendable. For instance, all monitor commands are
40implemented with the same call interface, so that it's very easy to
41add new commands. Also, instead of permanently adding rarely used
42code (for instance hardware test utilities) to the monitor, you can
43load and run it dynamically.
44
45
46Status:
47=======
48
49In general, all boards for which a configuration option exists in the
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +000050Makefile have been tested to some extent and can be considered
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000051"working". In fact, many of them are used in production systems.
52
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +000053In case of problems see the CHANGELOG and CREDITS files to find out
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +010054who contributed the specific port. The MAINTAINERS file lists board
55maintainers.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000056
Robert P. J. Dayadb9d852012-11-14 02:03:20 +000057Note: There is no CHANGELOG file in the actual U-Boot source tree;
58it can be created dynamically from the Git log using:
59
60 make CHANGELOG
61
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000062
63Where to get help:
64==================
65
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +000066In case you have questions about, problems with or contributions for
67U-Boot you should send a message to the U-Boot mailing list at
Peter Tyser0c325652008-09-10 09:18:34 -050068<u-boot@lists.denx.de>. There is also an archive of previous traffic
69on the mailing list - please search the archive before asking FAQ's.
70Please see http://lists.denx.de/pipermail/u-boot and
71http://dir.gmane.org/gmane.comp.boot-loaders.u-boot
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000072
73
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +010074Where to get source code:
75=========================
76
77The U-Boot source code is maintained in the git repository at
78git://www.denx.de/git/u-boot.git ; you can browse it online at
79http://www.denx.de/cgi-bin/gitweb.cgi?p=u-boot.git;a=summary
80
81The "snapshot" links on this page allow you to download tarballs of
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +020082any version you might be interested in. Official releases are also
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +010083available for FTP download from the ftp://ftp.denx.de/pub/u-boot/
84directory.
85
Anatolij Gustschind4ee7112008-03-26 18:13:33 +010086Pre-built (and tested) images are available from
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +010087ftp://ftp.denx.de/pub/u-boot/images/
88
89
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000090Where we come from:
91===================
92
93- start from 8xxrom sources
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +000094- create PPCBoot project (http://sourceforge.net/projects/ppcboot)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000095- clean up code
96- make it easier to add custom boards
97- make it possible to add other [PowerPC] CPUs
98- extend functions, especially:
99 * Provide extended interface to Linux boot loader
100 * S-Record download
101 * network boot
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +0200102 * PCMCIA / CompactFlash / ATA disk / SCSI ... boot
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +0000103- create ARMBoot project (http://sourceforge.net/projects/armboot)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000104- add other CPU families (starting with ARM)
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +0000105- create U-Boot project (http://sourceforge.net/projects/u-boot)
Magnus Lilja0d28f342008-08-06 19:32:33 +0200106- current project page: see http://www.denx.de/wiki/U-Boot
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +0000107
108
109Names and Spelling:
110===================
111
112The "official" name of this project is "Das U-Boot". The spelling
113"U-Boot" shall be used in all written text (documentation, comments
114in source files etc.). Example:
115
116 This is the README file for the U-Boot project.
117
118File names etc. shall be based on the string "u-boot". Examples:
119
120 include/asm-ppc/u-boot.h
121
122 #include <asm/u-boot.h>
123
124Variable names, preprocessor constants etc. shall be either based on
125the string "u_boot" or on "U_BOOT". Example:
126
127 U_BOOT_VERSION u_boot_logo
128 IH_OS_U_BOOT u_boot_hush_start
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000129
130
wdenk93f19cc2002-12-17 17:55:09 +0000131Versioning:
132===========
133
Thomas Weber360d8832010-09-28 08:06:25 +0200134Starting with the release in October 2008, the names of the releases
135were changed from numerical release numbers without deeper meaning
136into a time stamp based numbering. Regular releases are identified by
137names consisting of the calendar year and month of the release date.
138Additional fields (if present) indicate release candidates or bug fix
139releases in "stable" maintenance trees.
wdenk93f19cc2002-12-17 17:55:09 +0000140
Thomas Weber360d8832010-09-28 08:06:25 +0200141Examples:
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +0000142 U-Boot v2009.11 - Release November 2009
Thomas Weber360d8832010-09-28 08:06:25 +0200143 U-Boot v2009.11.1 - Release 1 in version November 2009 stable tree
144 U-Boot v2010.09-rc1 - Release candiate 1 for September 2010 release
wdenk93f19cc2002-12-17 17:55:09 +0000145
146
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000147Directory Hierarchy:
148====================
149
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500150/arch Architecture specific files
151 /arm Files generic to ARM architecture
152 /cpu CPU specific files
153 /arm720t Files specific to ARM 720 CPUs
154 /arm920t Files specific to ARM 920 CPUs
Andreas Bießmann6eb09212011-07-18 09:41:08 +0000155 /at91 Files specific to Atmel AT91RM9200 CPU
Wolfgang Denka9046b92010-06-13 17:48:15 +0200156 /imx Files specific to Freescale MC9328 i.MX CPUs
157 /s3c24x0 Files specific to Samsung S3C24X0 CPUs
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500158 /arm925t Files specific to ARM 925 CPUs
159 /arm926ejs Files specific to ARM 926 CPUs
160 /arm1136 Files specific to ARM 1136 CPUs
161 /ixp Files specific to Intel XScale IXP CPUs
162 /pxa Files specific to Intel XScale PXA CPUs
163 /s3c44b0 Files specific to Samsung S3C44B0 CPUs
164 /sa1100 Files specific to Intel StrongARM SA1100 CPUs
165 /lib Architecture specific library files
166 /avr32 Files generic to AVR32 architecture
167 /cpu CPU specific files
168 /lib Architecture specific library files
169 /blackfin Files generic to Analog Devices Blackfin architecture
170 /cpu CPU specific files
171 /lib Architecture specific library files
Graeme Russfea25722011-04-13 19:43:28 +1000172 /x86 Files generic to x86 architecture
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500173 /cpu CPU specific files
174 /lib Architecture specific library files
175 /m68k Files generic to m68k architecture
176 /cpu CPU specific files
177 /mcf52x2 Files specific to Freescale ColdFire MCF52x2 CPUs
178 /mcf5227x Files specific to Freescale ColdFire MCF5227x CPUs
179 /mcf532x Files specific to Freescale ColdFire MCF5329 CPUs
180 /mcf5445x Files specific to Freescale ColdFire MCF5445x CPUs
181 /mcf547x_8x Files specific to Freescale ColdFire MCF547x_8x CPUs
182 /lib Architecture specific library files
183 /microblaze Files generic to microblaze architecture
184 /cpu CPU specific files
185 /lib Architecture specific library files
186 /mips Files generic to MIPS architecture
187 /cpu CPU specific files
Daniel Schwierzeck92bbd642011-07-27 13:22:39 +0200188 /mips32 Files specific to MIPS32 CPUs
Xiangfu Liu80421fc2011-10-12 12:24:06 +0800189 /xburst Files specific to Ingenic XBurst CPUs
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500190 /lib Architecture specific library files
Macpaul Linafc1ce82011-10-19 20:41:11 +0000191 /nds32 Files generic to NDS32 architecture
192 /cpu CPU specific files
193 /n1213 Files specific to Andes Technology N1213 CPUs
194 /lib Architecture specific library files
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500195 /nios2 Files generic to Altera NIOS2 architecture
196 /cpu CPU specific files
197 /lib Architecture specific library files
Stefan Roesea47a12b2010-04-15 16:07:28 +0200198 /powerpc Files generic to PowerPC architecture
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500199 /cpu CPU specific files
200 /74xx_7xx Files specific to Freescale MPC74xx and 7xx CPUs
201 /mpc5xx Files specific to Freescale MPC5xx CPUs
202 /mpc5xxx Files specific to Freescale MPC5xxx CPUs
203 /mpc8xx Files specific to Freescale MPC8xx CPUs
204 /mpc8220 Files specific to Freescale MPC8220 CPUs
205 /mpc824x Files specific to Freescale MPC824x CPUs
206 /mpc8260 Files specific to Freescale MPC8260 CPUs
207 /mpc85xx Files specific to Freescale MPC85xx CPUs
208 /ppc4xx Files specific to AMCC PowerPC 4xx CPUs
209 /lib Architecture specific library files
210 /sh Files generic to SH architecture
211 /cpu CPU specific files
212 /sh2 Files specific to sh2 CPUs
213 /sh3 Files specific to sh3 CPUs
214 /sh4 Files specific to sh4 CPUs
215 /lib Architecture specific library files
216 /sparc Files generic to SPARC architecture
217 /cpu CPU specific files
218 /leon2 Files specific to Gaisler LEON2 SPARC CPU
219 /leon3 Files specific to Gaisler LEON3 SPARC CPU
220 /lib Architecture specific library files
221/api Machine/arch independent API for external apps
222/board Board dependent files
223/common Misc architecture independent functions
224/disk Code for disk drive partition handling
225/doc Documentation (don't expect too much)
226/drivers Commonly used device drivers
227/examples Example code for standalone applications, etc.
228/fs Filesystem code (cramfs, ext2, jffs2, etc.)
229/include Header Files
230/lib Files generic to all architectures
231 /libfdt Library files to support flattened device trees
232 /lzma Library files to support LZMA decompression
233 /lzo Library files to support LZO decompression
234/net Networking code
235/post Power On Self Test
236/rtc Real Time Clock drivers
237/tools Tools to build S-Record or U-Boot images, etc.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000238
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000239Software Configuration:
240=======================
241
242Configuration is usually done using C preprocessor defines; the
243rationale behind that is to avoid dead code whenever possible.
244
245There are two classes of configuration variables:
246
247* Configuration _OPTIONS_:
248 These are selectable by the user and have names beginning with
249 "CONFIG_".
250
251* Configuration _SETTINGS_:
252 These depend on the hardware etc. and should not be meddled with if
253 you don't know what you're doing; they have names beginning with
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200254 "CONFIG_SYS_".
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000255
256Later we will add a configuration tool - probably similar to or even
257identical to what's used for the Linux kernel. Right now, we have to
258do the configuration by hand, which means creating some symbolic
259links and editing some configuration files. We use the TQM8xxL boards
260as an example here.
261
262
263Selection of Processor Architecture and Board Type:
264---------------------------------------------------
265
266For all supported boards there are ready-to-use default
267configurations available; just type "make <board_name>_config".
268
269Example: For a TQM823L module type:
270
271 cd u-boot
272 make TQM823L_config
273
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +0200274For the Cogent platform, you need to specify the CPU type as well;
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000275e.g. "make cogent_mpc8xx_config". And also configure the cogent
276directory according to the instructions in cogent/README.
277
278
279Configuration Options:
280----------------------
281
282Configuration depends on the combination of board and CPU type; all
283such information is kept in a configuration file
284"include/configs/<board_name>.h".
285
286Example: For a TQM823L module, all configuration settings are in
287"include/configs/TQM823L.h".
288
289
wdenk7f6c2cb2002-11-10 22:06:23 +0000290Many of the options are named exactly as the corresponding Linux
291kernel configuration options. The intention is to make it easier to
292build a config tool - later.
293
294
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000295The following options need to be configured:
296
Kim Phillips26281142007-08-10 13:28:25 -0500297- CPU Type: Define exactly one, e.g. CONFIG_MPC85XX.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000298
Kim Phillips26281142007-08-10 13:28:25 -0500299- Board Type: Define exactly one, e.g. CONFIG_MPC8540ADS.
Wolfgang Denk6ccec442006-10-24 14:42:37 +0200300
301- CPU Daughterboard Type: (if CONFIG_ATSTK1000 is defined)
Haavard Skinnemoen09ea0de2007-11-01 12:44:20 +0100302 Define exactly one, e.g. CONFIG_ATSTK1002
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000303
304- CPU Module Type: (if CONFIG_COGENT is defined)
305 Define exactly one of
306 CONFIG_CMA286_60_OLD
307--- FIXME --- not tested yet:
308 CONFIG_CMA286_60, CONFIG_CMA286_21, CONFIG_CMA286_60P,
309 CONFIG_CMA287_23, CONFIG_CMA287_50
310
311- Motherboard Type: (if CONFIG_COGENT is defined)
312 Define exactly one of
313 CONFIG_CMA101, CONFIG_CMA102
314
315- Motherboard I/O Modules: (if CONFIG_COGENT is defined)
316 Define one or more of
317 CONFIG_CMA302
318
319- Motherboard Options: (if CONFIG_CMA101 or CONFIG_CMA102 are defined)
320 Define one or more of
321 CONFIG_LCD_HEARTBEAT - update a character position on
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +0200322 the LCD display every second with
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000323 a "rotator" |\-/|\-/
324
wdenk2535d602003-07-17 23:16:40 +0000325- Board flavour: (if CONFIG_MPC8260ADS is defined)
326 CONFIG_ADSTYPE
327 Possible values are:
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200328 CONFIG_SYS_8260ADS - original MPC8260ADS
329 CONFIG_SYS_8266ADS - MPC8266ADS
330 CONFIG_SYS_PQ2FADS - PQ2FADS-ZU or PQ2FADS-VR
331 CONFIG_SYS_8272ADS - MPC8272ADS
wdenk2535d602003-07-17 23:16:40 +0000332
Lei Wencf946c62011-02-09 18:06:58 +0530333- Marvell Family Member
334 CONFIG_SYS_MVFS - define it if you want to enable
335 multiple fs option at one time
336 for marvell soc family
337
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000338- MPC824X Family Member (if CONFIG_MPC824X is defined)
wdenk5da627a2003-10-09 20:09:04 +0000339 Define exactly one of
340 CONFIG_MPC8240, CONFIG_MPC8245
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000341
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +0200342- 8xx CPU Options: (if using an MPC8xx CPU)
wdenk66ca92a2004-09-28 17:59:53 +0000343 CONFIG_8xx_GCLK_FREQ - deprecated: CPU clock if
344 get_gclk_freq() cannot work
wdenk5da627a2003-10-09 20:09:04 +0000345 e.g. if there is no 32KHz
346 reference PIT/RTC clock
wdenk66ca92a2004-09-28 17:59:53 +0000347 CONFIG_8xx_OSCLK - PLL input clock (either EXTCLK
348 or XTAL/EXTAL)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000349
wdenk66ca92a2004-09-28 17:59:53 +0000350- 859/866/885 CPU options: (if using a MPC859 or MPC866 or MPC885 CPU):
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200351 CONFIG_SYS_8xx_CPUCLK_MIN
352 CONFIG_SYS_8xx_CPUCLK_MAX
wdenk66ca92a2004-09-28 17:59:53 +0000353 CONFIG_8xx_CPUCLK_DEFAULT
wdenk75d1ea72004-01-31 20:06:54 +0000354 See doc/README.MPC866
355
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200356 CONFIG_SYS_MEASURE_CPUCLK
wdenk75d1ea72004-01-31 20:06:54 +0000357
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +0000358 Define this to measure the actual CPU clock instead
359 of relying on the correctness of the configured
360 values. Mostly useful for board bringup to make sure
361 the PLL is locked at the intended frequency. Note
362 that this requires a (stable) reference clock (32 kHz
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200363 RTC clock or CONFIG_SYS_8XX_XIN)
wdenk75d1ea72004-01-31 20:06:54 +0000364
Heiko Schocher506f3912009-03-12 07:37:15 +0100365 CONFIG_SYS_DELAYED_ICACHE
366
367 Define this option if you want to enable the
368 ICache only when Code runs from RAM.
369
Kumar Gala66412c62011-02-18 05:40:54 -0600370- 85xx CPU Options:
York Sunffd06e02012-10-08 07:44:30 +0000371 CONFIG_SYS_PPC64
372
373 Specifies that the core is a 64-bit PowerPC implementation (implements
374 the "64" category of the Power ISA). This is necessary for ePAPR
375 compliance, among other possible reasons.
376
Kumar Gala66412c62011-02-18 05:40:54 -0600377 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_TBCLK_DIV
378
379 Defines the core time base clock divider ratio compared to the
380 system clock. On most PQ3 devices this is 8, on newer QorIQ
381 devices it can be 16 or 32. The ratio varies from SoC to Soc.
382
Kumar Gala8f290842011-05-20 00:39:21 -0500383 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_PCIE_COMPAT
384
385 Defines the string to utilize when trying to match PCIe device
386 tree nodes for the given platform.
387
Prabhakar Kushwahaafa6b552012-04-29 23:56:13 +0000388 CONFIG_SYS_PPC_E500_DEBUG_TLB
389
390 Enables a temporary TLB entry to be used during boot to work
391 around limitations in e500v1 and e500v2 external debugger
392 support. This reduces the portions of the boot code where
393 breakpoints and single stepping do not work. The value of this
394 symbol should be set to the TLB1 entry to be used for this
395 purpose.
396
Scott Wood33eee332012-08-14 10:14:53 +0000397 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_ERRATUM_A004510
398
399 Enables a workaround for erratum A004510. If set,
400 then CONFIG_SYS_FSL_ERRATUM_A004510_SVR_REV and
401 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_CORENET_SNOOPVEC_COREONLY must be set.
402
403 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_ERRATUM_A004510_SVR_REV
404 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_ERRATUM_A004510_SVR_REV2 (optional)
405
406 Defines one or two SoC revisions (low 8 bits of SVR)
407 for which the A004510 workaround should be applied.
408
409 The rest of SVR is either not relevant to the decision
410 of whether the erratum is present (e.g. p2040 versus
411 p2041) or is implied by the build target, which controls
412 whether CONFIG_SYS_FSL_ERRATUM_A004510 is set.
413
414 See Freescale App Note 4493 for more information about
415 this erratum.
416
417 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_CORENET_SNOOPVEC_COREONLY
418
419 This is the value to write into CCSR offset 0x18600
420 according to the A004510 workaround.
421
Daniel Schwierzeck6cb461b2012-04-02 02:57:56 +0000422- Generic CPU options:
423 CONFIG_SYS_BIG_ENDIAN, CONFIG_SYS_LITTLE_ENDIAN
424
425 Defines the endianess of the CPU. Implementation of those
426 values is arch specific.
427
Markus Klotzbuecher0b953ff2006-03-24 15:28:02 +0100428- Intel Monahans options:
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200429 CONFIG_SYS_MONAHANS_RUN_MODE_OSC_RATIO
Markus Klotzbuecher0b953ff2006-03-24 15:28:02 +0100430
431 Defines the Monahans run mode to oscillator
432 ratio. Valid values are 8, 16, 24, 31. The core
433 frequency is this value multiplied by 13 MHz.
434
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200435 CONFIG_SYS_MONAHANS_TURBO_RUN_MODE_RATIO
Wolfgang Denkcf48eb92006-04-16 10:51:58 +0200436
Markus Klotzbuecher0b953ff2006-03-24 15:28:02 +0100437 Defines the Monahans turbo mode to oscillator
438 ratio. Valid values are 1 (default if undefined) and
Wolfgang Denkcf48eb92006-04-16 10:51:58 +0200439 2. The core frequency as calculated above is multiplied
Markus Klotzbuecher0b953ff2006-03-24 15:28:02 +0100440 by this value.
Wolfgang Denkcf48eb92006-04-16 10:51:58 +0200441
Daniel Schwierzeck92bbd642011-07-27 13:22:39 +0200442- MIPS CPU options:
443 CONFIG_SYS_INIT_SP_OFFSET
444
445 Offset relative to CONFIG_SYS_SDRAM_BASE for initial stack
446 pointer. This is needed for the temporary stack before
447 relocation.
448
449 CONFIG_SYS_MIPS_CACHE_MODE
450
451 Cache operation mode for the MIPS CPU.
452 See also arch/mips/include/asm/mipsregs.h.
453 Possible values are:
454 CONF_CM_CACHABLE_NO_WA
455 CONF_CM_CACHABLE_WA
456 CONF_CM_UNCACHED
457 CONF_CM_CACHABLE_NONCOHERENT
458 CONF_CM_CACHABLE_CE
459 CONF_CM_CACHABLE_COW
460 CONF_CM_CACHABLE_CUW
461 CONF_CM_CACHABLE_ACCELERATED
462
463 CONFIG_SYS_XWAY_EBU_BOOTCFG
464
465 Special option for Lantiq XWAY SoCs for booting from NOR flash.
466 See also arch/mips/cpu/mips32/start.S.
467
468 CONFIG_XWAY_SWAP_BYTES
469
470 Enable compilation of tools/xway-swap-bytes needed for Lantiq
471 XWAY SoCs for booting from NOR flash. The U-Boot image needs to
472 be swapped if a flash programmer is used.
473
Christian Rieschb67d8812012-02-02 00:44:39 +0000474- ARM options:
475 CONFIG_SYS_EXCEPTION_VECTORS_HIGH
476
477 Select high exception vectors of the ARM core, e.g., do not
478 clear the V bit of the c1 register of CP15.
479
Aneesh V5356f542012-03-08 07:20:19 +0000480 CONFIG_SYS_THUMB_BUILD
481
482 Use this flag to build U-Boot using the Thumb instruction
483 set for ARM architectures. Thumb instruction set provides
484 better code density. For ARM architectures that support
485 Thumb2 this flag will result in Thumb2 code generated by
486 GCC.
487
Stephen Warrenc5d47522013-03-04 13:29:40 +0000488 CONFIG_ARM_ERRATA_716044
Stephen Warren06785872013-02-26 12:28:27 +0000489 CONFIG_ARM_ERRATA_742230
490 CONFIG_ARM_ERRATA_743622
491 CONFIG_ARM_ERRATA_751472
492
493 If set, the workarounds for these ARM errata are applied early
494 during U-Boot startup. Note that these options force the
495 workarounds to be applied; no CPU-type/version detection
496 exists, unlike the similar options in the Linux kernel. Do not
497 set these options unless they apply!
498
Stephen Warren795659d2013-03-27 17:06:41 +0000499- CPU timer options:
500 CONFIG_SYS_HZ
501
502 The frequency of the timer returned by get_timer().
503 get_timer() must operate in milliseconds and this CONFIG
504 option must be set to 1000.
505
wdenk5da627a2003-10-09 20:09:04 +0000506- Linux Kernel Interface:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000507 CONFIG_CLOCKS_IN_MHZ
508
509 U-Boot stores all clock information in Hz
510 internally. For binary compatibility with older Linux
511 kernels (which expect the clocks passed in the
512 bd_info data to be in MHz) the environment variable
513 "clocks_in_mhz" can be defined so that U-Boot
514 converts clock data to MHZ before passing it to the
515 Linux kernel.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000516 When CONFIG_CLOCKS_IN_MHZ is defined, a definition of
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +0100517 "clocks_in_mhz=1" is automatically included in the
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000518 default environment.
519
wdenk5da627a2003-10-09 20:09:04 +0000520 CONFIG_MEMSIZE_IN_BYTES [relevant for MIPS only]
521
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +0200522 When transferring memsize parameter to linux, some versions
wdenk5da627a2003-10-09 20:09:04 +0000523 expect it to be in bytes, others in MB.
524 Define CONFIG_MEMSIZE_IN_BYTES to make it in bytes.
525
Gerald Van Barenfec6d9e2008-06-03 20:34:45 -0400526 CONFIG_OF_LIBFDT
Wolfgang Denkf57f70a2005-10-13 01:45:54 +0200527
528 New kernel versions are expecting firmware settings to be
Gerald Van Baren213bf8c2007-03-31 12:23:51 -0400529 passed using flattened device trees (based on open firmware
530 concepts).
531
532 CONFIG_OF_LIBFDT
533 * New libfdt-based support
534 * Adds the "fdt" command
Kim Phillips3bb342f2007-08-10 14:34:14 -0500535 * The bootm command automatically updates the fdt
Gerald Van Baren213bf8c2007-03-31 12:23:51 -0400536
Marcel Ziswilerb55ae402009-09-09 21:18:41 +0200537 OF_CPU - The proper name of the cpus node (only required for
538 MPC512X and MPC5xxx based boards).
539 OF_SOC - The proper name of the soc node (only required for
540 MPC512X and MPC5xxx based boards).
Wolfgang Denkf57f70a2005-10-13 01:45:54 +0200541 OF_TBCLK - The timebase frequency.
Kumar Galac2871f02006-01-11 13:59:02 -0600542 OF_STDOUT_PATH - The path to the console device
Wolfgang Denkf57f70a2005-10-13 01:45:54 +0200543
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +0200544 boards with QUICC Engines require OF_QE to set UCC MAC
545 addresses
Kim Phillips3bb342f2007-08-10 14:34:14 -0500546
Kumar Gala4e253132006-01-11 13:54:17 -0600547 CONFIG_OF_BOARD_SETUP
548
549 Board code has addition modification that it wants to make
550 to the flat device tree before handing it off to the kernel
wdenk6705d812004-08-02 23:22:59 +0000551
Matthew McClintock02677682006-06-28 10:41:37 -0500552 CONFIG_OF_BOOT_CPU
553
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +0200554 This define fills in the correct boot CPU in the boot
Matthew McClintock02677682006-06-28 10:41:37 -0500555 param header, the default value is zero if undefined.
556
Heiko Schocher3887c3f2009-09-23 07:56:08 +0200557 CONFIG_OF_IDE_FIXUP
558
559 U-Boot can detect if an IDE device is present or not.
560 If not, and this new config option is activated, U-Boot
561 removes the ATA node from the DTS before booting Linux,
562 so the Linux IDE driver does not probe the device and
563 crash. This is needed for buggy hardware (uc101) where
564 no pull down resistor is connected to the signal IDE5V_DD7.
565
Igor Grinberg7eb29392011-07-14 05:45:07 +0000566 CONFIG_MACH_TYPE [relevant for ARM only][mandatory]
567
568 This setting is mandatory for all boards that have only one
569 machine type and must be used to specify the machine type
570 number as it appears in the ARM machine registry
571 (see http://www.arm.linux.org.uk/developer/machines/).
572 Only boards that have multiple machine types supported
573 in a single configuration file and the machine type is
574 runtime discoverable, do not have to use this setting.
575
Niklaus Giger0b2f4ec2008-11-03 22:13:47 +0100576- vxWorks boot parameters:
577
578 bootvx constructs a valid bootline using the following
579 environments variables: bootfile, ipaddr, serverip, hostname.
580 It loads the vxWorks image pointed bootfile.
581
582 CONFIG_SYS_VXWORKS_BOOT_DEVICE - The vxworks device name
583 CONFIG_SYS_VXWORKS_MAC_PTR - Ethernet 6 byte MA -address
584 CONFIG_SYS_VXWORKS_SERVERNAME - Name of the server
585 CONFIG_SYS_VXWORKS_BOOT_ADDR - Address of boot parameters
586
587 CONFIG_SYS_VXWORKS_ADD_PARAMS
588
589 Add it at the end of the bootline. E.g "u=username pw=secret"
590
591 Note: If a "bootargs" environment is defined, it will overwride
592 the defaults discussed just above.
593
Aneesh V2c451f72011-06-16 23:30:47 +0000594- Cache Configuration:
595 CONFIG_SYS_ICACHE_OFF - Do not enable instruction cache in U-Boot
596 CONFIG_SYS_DCACHE_OFF - Do not enable data cache in U-Boot
597 CONFIG_SYS_L2CACHE_OFF- Do not enable L2 cache in U-Boot
598
Aneesh V93bc2192011-06-16 23:30:51 +0000599- Cache Configuration for ARM:
600 CONFIG_SYS_L2_PL310 - Enable support for ARM PL310 L2 cache
601 controller
602 CONFIG_SYS_PL310_BASE - Physical base address of PL310
603 controller register space
604
wdenk6705d812004-08-02 23:22:59 +0000605- Serial Ports:
Andreas Engel48d01922008-09-08 14:30:53 +0200606 CONFIG_PL010_SERIAL
wdenk6705d812004-08-02 23:22:59 +0000607
608 Define this if you want support for Amba PrimeCell PL010 UARTs.
609
Andreas Engel48d01922008-09-08 14:30:53 +0200610 CONFIG_PL011_SERIAL
wdenk6705d812004-08-02 23:22:59 +0000611
612 Define this if you want support for Amba PrimeCell PL011 UARTs.
613
614 CONFIG_PL011_CLOCK
615
616 If you have Amba PrimeCell PL011 UARTs, set this variable to
617 the clock speed of the UARTs.
618
619 CONFIG_PL01x_PORTS
620
621 If you have Amba PrimeCell PL010 or PL011 UARTs on your board,
622 define this to a list of base addresses for each (supported)
623 port. See e.g. include/configs/versatile.h
624
John Rigby910f1ae2011-04-19 10:42:39 +0000625 CONFIG_PL011_SERIAL_RLCR
626
627 Some vendor versions of PL011 serial ports (e.g. ST-Ericsson U8500)
628 have separate receive and transmit line control registers. Set
629 this variable to initialize the extra register.
630
631 CONFIG_PL011_SERIAL_FLUSH_ON_INIT
632
633 On some platforms (e.g. U8500) U-Boot is loaded by a second stage
634 boot loader that has already initialized the UART. Define this
635 variable to flush the UART at init time.
636
Javier Martinez Canillas7de0fe12013-01-07 01:35:20 +0000637 CONFIG_SYS_NS16550_BROKEN_TEMT
638
639 16550 UART set the Transmitter Empty (TEMT) Bit when all output
640 has finished and the transmitter is totally empty. U-Boot waits
641 for this bit to be set to initialize the serial console. On some
642 broken platforms this bit is not set in SPL making U-Boot to
643 hang while waiting for TEMT. Define this option to avoid it.
644
wdenk6705d812004-08-02 23:22:59 +0000645
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000646- Console Interface:
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +0000647 Depending on board, define exactly one serial port
648 (like CONFIG_8xx_CONS_SMC1, CONFIG_8xx_CONS_SMC2,
649 CONFIG_8xx_CONS_SCC1, ...), or switch off the serial
650 console by defining CONFIG_8xx_CONS_NONE
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000651
652 Note: if CONFIG_8xx_CONS_NONE is defined, the serial
653 port routines must be defined elsewhere
654 (i.e. serial_init(), serial_getc(), ...)
655
656 CONFIG_CFB_CONSOLE
657 Enables console device for a color framebuffer. Needs following
Wolfgang Denkc53043b2011-12-07 12:19:20 +0000658 defines (cf. smiLynxEM, i8042)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000659 VIDEO_FB_LITTLE_ENDIAN graphic memory organisation
660 (default big endian)
661 VIDEO_HW_RECTFILL graphic chip supports
662 rectangle fill
663 (cf. smiLynxEM)
664 VIDEO_HW_BITBLT graphic chip supports
665 bit-blit (cf. smiLynxEM)
666 VIDEO_VISIBLE_COLS visible pixel columns
667 (cols=pitch)
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +0000668 VIDEO_VISIBLE_ROWS visible pixel rows
669 VIDEO_PIXEL_SIZE bytes per pixel
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000670 VIDEO_DATA_FORMAT graphic data format
671 (0-5, cf. cfb_console.c)
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +0000672 VIDEO_FB_ADRS framebuffer address
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000673 VIDEO_KBD_INIT_FCT keyboard int fct
674 (i.e. i8042_kbd_init())
675 VIDEO_TSTC_FCT test char fct
676 (i.e. i8042_tstc)
677 VIDEO_GETC_FCT get char fct
678 (i.e. i8042_getc)
679 CONFIG_CONSOLE_CURSOR cursor drawing on/off
680 (requires blink timer
681 cf. i8042.c)
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200682 CONFIG_SYS_CONSOLE_BLINK_COUNT blink interval (cf. i8042.c)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000683 CONFIG_CONSOLE_TIME display time/date info in
684 upper right corner
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500685 (requires CONFIG_CMD_DATE)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000686 CONFIG_VIDEO_LOGO display Linux logo in
687 upper left corner
wdenka6c7ad22002-12-03 21:28:10 +0000688 CONFIG_VIDEO_BMP_LOGO use bmp_logo.h instead of
689 linux_logo.h for logo.
690 Requires CONFIG_VIDEO_LOGO
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000691 CONFIG_CONSOLE_EXTRA_INFO
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +0200692 additional board info beside
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000693 the logo
694
Pali Rohár33a35bb2012-10-19 13:30:09 +0000695 When CONFIG_CFB_CONSOLE_ANSI is defined, console will support
696 a limited number of ANSI escape sequences (cursor control,
697 erase functions and limited graphics rendition control).
698
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +0000699 When CONFIG_CFB_CONSOLE is defined, video console is
700 default i/o. Serial console can be forced with
701 environment 'console=serial'.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000702
wdenkd4ca31c2004-01-02 14:00:00 +0000703 When CONFIG_SILENT_CONSOLE is defined, all console
704 messages (by U-Boot and Linux!) can be silenced with
705 the "silent" environment variable. See
706 doc/README.silent for more information.
wdenka3ad8e22003-10-19 23:22:11 +0000707
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000708- Console Baudrate:
709 CONFIG_BAUDRATE - in bps
710 Select one of the baudrates listed in
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200711 CONFIG_SYS_BAUDRATE_TABLE, see below.
712 CONFIG_SYS_BRGCLK_PRESCALE, baudrate prescale
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000713
Heiko Schocherc92fac92009-01-30 12:55:38 +0100714- Console Rx buffer length
715 With CONFIG_SYS_SMC_RXBUFLEN it is possible to define
716 the maximum receive buffer length for the SMC.
Heiko Schocher2b3f12c2009-02-10 09:31:47 +0100717 This option is actual only for 82xx and 8xx possible.
Heiko Schocherc92fac92009-01-30 12:55:38 +0100718 If using CONFIG_SYS_SMC_RXBUFLEN also CONFIG_SYS_MAXIDLE
719 must be defined, to setup the maximum idle timeout for
720 the SMC.
721
Graeme Russ9558b482011-09-01 00:48:27 +0000722- Pre-Console Buffer:
Wolfgang Denk4cf26092011-10-07 09:58:21 +0200723 Prior to the console being initialised (i.e. serial UART
724 initialised etc) all console output is silently discarded.
725 Defining CONFIG_PRE_CONSOLE_BUFFER will cause U-Boot to
726 buffer any console messages prior to the console being
727 initialised to a buffer of size CONFIG_PRE_CON_BUF_SZ
728 bytes located at CONFIG_PRE_CON_BUF_ADDR. The buffer is
729 a circular buffer, so if more than CONFIG_PRE_CON_BUF_SZ
Wolfgang Denk6feff892011-10-09 21:06:34 +0200730 bytes are output before the console is initialised, the
Wolfgang Denk4cf26092011-10-07 09:58:21 +0200731 earlier bytes are discarded.
Graeme Russ9558b482011-09-01 00:48:27 +0000732
Wolfgang Denk4cf26092011-10-07 09:58:21 +0200733 'Sane' compilers will generate smaller code if
734 CONFIG_PRE_CON_BUF_SZ is a power of 2
Graeme Russ9558b482011-09-01 00:48:27 +0000735
Sonny Rao046a37b2011-11-02 09:52:08 +0000736- Safe printf() functions
737 Define CONFIG_SYS_VSNPRINTF to compile in safe versions of
738 the printf() functions. These are defined in
739 include/vsprintf.h and include snprintf(), vsnprintf() and
740 so on. Code size increase is approximately 300-500 bytes.
741 If this option is not given then these functions will
742 silently discard their buffer size argument - this means
743 you are not getting any overflow checking in this case.
744
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000745- Boot Delay: CONFIG_BOOTDELAY - in seconds
746 Delay before automatically booting the default image;
747 set to -1 to disable autoboot.
Joe Hershberger93d72122012-08-17 10:53:12 +0000748 set to -2 to autoboot with no delay and not check for abort
749 (even when CONFIG_ZERO_BOOTDELAY_CHECK is defined).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000750
751 See doc/README.autoboot for these options that
752 work with CONFIG_BOOTDELAY. None are required.
753 CONFIG_BOOT_RETRY_TIME
754 CONFIG_BOOT_RETRY_MIN
755 CONFIG_AUTOBOOT_KEYED
756 CONFIG_AUTOBOOT_PROMPT
757 CONFIG_AUTOBOOT_DELAY_STR
758 CONFIG_AUTOBOOT_STOP_STR
759 CONFIG_AUTOBOOT_DELAY_STR2
760 CONFIG_AUTOBOOT_STOP_STR2
761 CONFIG_ZERO_BOOTDELAY_CHECK
762 CONFIG_RESET_TO_RETRY
763
764- Autoboot Command:
765 CONFIG_BOOTCOMMAND
766 Only needed when CONFIG_BOOTDELAY is enabled;
767 define a command string that is automatically executed
768 when no character is read on the console interface
769 within "Boot Delay" after reset.
770
771 CONFIG_BOOTARGS
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +0000772 This can be used to pass arguments to the bootm
773 command. The value of CONFIG_BOOTARGS goes into the
774 environment value "bootargs".
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000775
776 CONFIG_RAMBOOT and CONFIG_NFSBOOT
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +0000777 The value of these goes into the environment as
778 "ramboot" and "nfsboot" respectively, and can be used
779 as a convenience, when switching between booting from
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +0200780 RAM and NFS.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000781
782- Pre-Boot Commands:
783 CONFIG_PREBOOT
784
785 When this option is #defined, the existence of the
786 environment variable "preboot" will be checked
787 immediately before starting the CONFIG_BOOTDELAY
788 countdown and/or running the auto-boot command resp.
789 entering interactive mode.
790
791 This feature is especially useful when "preboot" is
792 automatically generated or modified. For an example
793 see the LWMON board specific code: here "preboot" is
794 modified when the user holds down a certain
795 combination of keys on the (special) keyboard when
796 booting the systems
797
798- Serial Download Echo Mode:
799 CONFIG_LOADS_ECHO
800 If defined to 1, all characters received during a
801 serial download (using the "loads" command) are
802 echoed back. This might be needed by some terminal
803 emulations (like "cu"), but may as well just take
804 time on others. This setting #define's the initial
805 value of the "loads_echo" environment variable.
806
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500807- Kgdb Serial Baudrate: (if CONFIG_CMD_KGDB is defined)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000808 CONFIG_KGDB_BAUDRATE
809 Select one of the baudrates listed in
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200810 CONFIG_SYS_BAUDRATE_TABLE, see below.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000811
812- Monitor Functions:
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500813 Monitor commands can be included or excluded
814 from the build by using the #include files
Stephen Warrenc6c621b2012-08-05 16:07:19 +0000815 <config_cmd_all.h> and #undef'ing unwanted
816 commands, or using <config_cmd_default.h>
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500817 and augmenting with additional #define's
818 for wanted commands.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000819
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500820 The default command configuration includes all commands
821 except those marked below with a "*".
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000822
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500823 CONFIG_CMD_ASKENV * ask for env variable
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500824 CONFIG_CMD_BDI bdinfo
825 CONFIG_CMD_BEDBUG * Include BedBug Debugger
826 CONFIG_CMD_BMP * BMP support
827 CONFIG_CMD_BSP * Board specific commands
828 CONFIG_CMD_BOOTD bootd
829 CONFIG_CMD_CACHE * icache, dcache
830 CONFIG_CMD_CONSOLE coninfo
Mike Frysinger710b9932010-12-21 14:19:51 -0500831 CONFIG_CMD_CRC32 * crc32
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500832 CONFIG_CMD_DATE * support for RTC, date/time...
833 CONFIG_CMD_DHCP * DHCP support
834 CONFIG_CMD_DIAG * Diagnostics
Peter Tysera7c93102008-12-17 16:36:22 -0600835 CONFIG_CMD_DS4510 * ds4510 I2C gpio commands
836 CONFIG_CMD_DS4510_INFO * ds4510 I2C info command
837 CONFIG_CMD_DS4510_MEM * ds4510 I2C eeprom/sram commansd
838 CONFIG_CMD_DS4510_RST * ds4510 I2C rst command
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500839 CONFIG_CMD_DTT * Digital Therm and Thermostat
840 CONFIG_CMD_ECHO echo arguments
Peter Tyser246c6922009-10-25 15:12:56 -0500841 CONFIG_CMD_EDITENV edit env variable
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500842 CONFIG_CMD_EEPROM * EEPROM read/write support
843 CONFIG_CMD_ELF * bootelf, bootvx
Joe Hershberger5e2b3e02012-12-11 22:16:25 -0600844 CONFIG_CMD_ENV_CALLBACK * display details about env callbacks
Joe Hershbergerfffad712012-12-11 22:16:33 -0600845 CONFIG_CMD_ENV_FLAGS * display details about env flags
Mike Frysinger0c79cda2010-12-26 23:09:45 -0500846 CONFIG_CMD_EXPORTENV * export the environment
Stephen Warren03e2ecf2012-10-22 06:43:50 +0000847 CONFIG_CMD_EXT2 * ext2 command support
848 CONFIG_CMD_EXT4 * ext4 command support
Mike Frysingerbdab39d2009-01-28 19:08:14 -0500849 CONFIG_CMD_SAVEENV saveenv
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500850 CONFIG_CMD_FDC * Floppy Disk Support
Stephen Warren03e2ecf2012-10-22 06:43:50 +0000851 CONFIG_CMD_FAT * FAT command support
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500852 CONFIG_CMD_FDOS * Dos diskette Support
853 CONFIG_CMD_FLASH flinfo, erase, protect
854 CONFIG_CMD_FPGA FPGA device initialization support
Anton Staaf53fdc7e2012-12-05 14:46:29 +0000855 CONFIG_CMD_GETTIME * Get time since boot
Mike Frysingera641b972010-12-26 23:32:22 -0500856 CONFIG_CMD_GO * the 'go' command (exec code)
Kim Phillipsa000b792011-04-05 07:15:14 +0000857 CONFIG_CMD_GREPENV * search environment
Simon Glassbf36c5d2012-12-05 14:46:38 +0000858 CONFIG_CMD_HASH * calculate hash / digest
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500859 CONFIG_CMD_HWFLOW * RTS/CTS hw flow control
860 CONFIG_CMD_I2C * I2C serial bus support
861 CONFIG_CMD_IDE * IDE harddisk support
862 CONFIG_CMD_IMI iminfo
Vipin Kumar8fdf1e02012-12-16 22:32:48 +0000863 CONFIG_CMD_IMLS List all images found in NOR flash
864 CONFIG_CMD_IMLS_NAND List all images found in NAND flash
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500865 CONFIG_CMD_IMMAP * IMMR dump support
Mike Frysinger0c79cda2010-12-26 23:09:45 -0500866 CONFIG_CMD_IMPORTENV * import an environment
Joe Hershbergerc167cc02012-10-03 11:15:51 +0000867 CONFIG_CMD_INI * import data from an ini file into the env
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500868 CONFIG_CMD_IRQ * irqinfo
869 CONFIG_CMD_ITEST Integer/string test of 2 values
870 CONFIG_CMD_JFFS2 * JFFS2 Support
871 CONFIG_CMD_KGDB * kgdb
Mike Frysinger1ba7fd22010-12-26 12:34:49 -0500872 CONFIG_CMD_LDRINFO ldrinfo (display Blackfin loader)
Joe Hershbergerd22c3382012-05-23 08:00:12 +0000873 CONFIG_CMD_LINK_LOCAL * link-local IP address auto-configuration
874 (169.254.*.*)
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500875 CONFIG_CMD_LOADB loadb
876 CONFIG_CMD_LOADS loads
Robin Getz02c9aa12009-07-27 00:07:59 -0400877 CONFIG_CMD_MD5SUM print md5 message digest
878 (requires CONFIG_CMD_MEMORY and CONFIG_MD5)
Simon Glass15a33e42012-11-30 13:01:20 +0000879 CONFIG_CMD_MEMINFO * Display detailed memory information
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500880 CONFIG_CMD_MEMORY md, mm, nm, mw, cp, cmp, crc, base,
Wolfgang Denka2681702013-03-08 10:51:32 +0000881 loop, loopw
882 CONFIG_CMD_MEMTEST mtest
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500883 CONFIG_CMD_MISC Misc functions like sleep etc
884 CONFIG_CMD_MMC * MMC memory mapped support
885 CONFIG_CMD_MII * MII utility commands
Stefan Roese68d7d652009-03-19 13:30:36 +0100886 CONFIG_CMD_MTDPARTS * MTD partition support
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500887 CONFIG_CMD_NAND * NAND support
888 CONFIG_CMD_NET bootp, tftpboot, rarpboot
Peter Tysere92739d2008-12-17 16:36:21 -0600889 CONFIG_CMD_PCA953X * PCA953x I2C gpio commands
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +0000890 CONFIG_CMD_PCA953X_INFO * PCA953x I2C gpio info command
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500891 CONFIG_CMD_PCI * pciinfo
892 CONFIG_CMD_PCMCIA * PCMCIA support
893 CONFIG_CMD_PING * send ICMP ECHO_REQUEST to network
894 host
895 CONFIG_CMD_PORTIO * Port I/O
Kenneth Watersff048ea2012-12-05 14:46:30 +0000896 CONFIG_CMD_READ * Read raw data from partition
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500897 CONFIG_CMD_REGINFO * Register dump
898 CONFIG_CMD_RUN run command in env variable
Simon Glassd3049312012-12-26 09:53:36 +0000899 CONFIG_CMD_SANDBOX * sb command to access sandbox features
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500900 CONFIG_CMD_SAVES * save S record dump
901 CONFIG_CMD_SCSI * SCSI Support
902 CONFIG_CMD_SDRAM * print SDRAM configuration information
903 (requires CONFIG_CMD_I2C)
904 CONFIG_CMD_SETGETDCR Support for DCR Register access
905 (4xx only)
Eric Nelsonf61ec452012-01-31 10:52:08 -0700906 CONFIG_CMD_SF * Read/write/erase SPI NOR flash
Alexander Hollerc6b1ee62011-01-18 09:48:08 +0100907 CONFIG_CMD_SHA1SUM print sha1 memory digest
Robin Getz02c9aa12009-07-27 00:07:59 -0400908 (requires CONFIG_CMD_MEMORY)
Wolfgang Denk74de7ae2009-04-01 23:34:12 +0200909 CONFIG_CMD_SOURCE "source" command Support
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500910 CONFIG_CMD_SPI * SPI serial bus support
Luca Ceresoli7a83af02011-05-17 00:03:40 +0000911 CONFIG_CMD_TFTPSRV * TFTP transfer in server mode
Simon Glass1fb7cd42011-10-24 18:00:07 +0000912 CONFIG_CMD_TFTPPUT * TFTP put command (upload)
Joe Hershbergerda83bcd2012-10-03 12:14:57 +0000913 CONFIG_CMD_TIME * run command and report execution time (ARM specific)
914 CONFIG_CMD_TIMER * access to the system tick timer
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500915 CONFIG_CMD_USB * USB support
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500916 CONFIG_CMD_CDP * Cisco Discover Protocol support
Marek Vasutc8339f52012-03-31 07:47:16 +0000917 CONFIG_CMD_MFSL * Microblaze FSL support
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000918
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000919
920 EXAMPLE: If you want all functions except of network
921 support you can write:
922
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500923 #include "config_cmd_all.h"
924 #undef CONFIG_CMD_NET
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000925
Gerald Van Baren213bf8c2007-03-31 12:23:51 -0400926 Other Commands:
927 fdt (flattened device tree) command: CONFIG_OF_LIBFDT
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000928
929 Note: Don't enable the "icache" and "dcache" commands
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500930 (configuration option CONFIG_CMD_CACHE) unless you know
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +0000931 what you (and your U-Boot users) are doing. Data
932 cache cannot be enabled on systems like the 8xx or
933 8260 (where accesses to the IMMR region must be
934 uncached), and it cannot be disabled on all other
935 systems where we (mis-) use the data cache to hold an
936 initial stack and some data.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000937
938
939 XXX - this list needs to get updated!
940
Simon Glass45ba8072011-10-15 05:48:20 +0000941- Device tree:
942 CONFIG_OF_CONTROL
943 If this variable is defined, U-Boot will use a device tree
944 to configure its devices, instead of relying on statically
945 compiled #defines in the board file. This option is
946 experimental and only available on a few boards. The device
947 tree is available in the global data as gd->fdt_blob.
948
Simon Glass2c0f79e2011-10-24 19:15:31 +0000949 U-Boot needs to get its device tree from somewhere. This can
950 be done using one of the two options below:
Simon Glassbbb0b122011-10-15 05:48:21 +0000951
952 CONFIG_OF_EMBED
953 If this variable is defined, U-Boot will embed a device tree
954 binary in its image. This device tree file should be in the
955 board directory and called <soc>-<board>.dts. The binary file
956 is then picked up in board_init_f() and made available through
957 the global data structure as gd->blob.
Simon Glass45ba8072011-10-15 05:48:20 +0000958
Simon Glass2c0f79e2011-10-24 19:15:31 +0000959 CONFIG_OF_SEPARATE
960 If this variable is defined, U-Boot will build a device tree
961 binary. It will be called u-boot.dtb. Architecture-specific
962 code will locate it at run-time. Generally this works by:
963
964 cat u-boot.bin u-boot.dtb >image.bin
965
966 and in fact, U-Boot does this for you, creating a file called
967 u-boot-dtb.bin which is useful in the common case. You can
968 still use the individual files if you need something more
969 exotic.
970
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000971- Watchdog:
972 CONFIG_WATCHDOG
973 If this variable is defined, it enables watchdog
Detlev Zundel6abe6fb2011-04-27 05:25:59 +0000974 support for the SoC. There must be support in the SoC
975 specific code for a watchdog. For the 8xx and 8260
976 CPUs, the SIU Watchdog feature is enabled in the SYPCR
977 register. When supported for a specific SoC is
978 available, then no further board specific code should
979 be needed to use it.
980
981 CONFIG_HW_WATCHDOG
982 When using a watchdog circuitry external to the used
983 SoC, then define this variable and provide board
984 specific code for the "hw_watchdog_reset" function.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000985
stroesec1551ea2003-04-04 15:53:41 +0000986- U-Boot Version:
987 CONFIG_VERSION_VARIABLE
988 If this variable is defined, an environment variable
989 named "ver" is created by U-Boot showing the U-Boot
990 version as printed by the "version" command.
Benoît Thébaudeaua1ea8e52012-08-13 15:01:14 +0200991 Any change to this variable will be reverted at the
992 next reset.
stroesec1551ea2003-04-04 15:53:41 +0000993
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000994- Real-Time Clock:
995
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500996 When CONFIG_CMD_DATE is selected, the type of the RTC
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000997 has to be selected, too. Define exactly one of the
998 following options:
999
1000 CONFIG_RTC_MPC8xx - use internal RTC of MPC8xx
1001 CONFIG_RTC_PCF8563 - use Philips PCF8563 RTC
Fabio Estevam4e8b7542011-10-24 06:44:15 +00001002 CONFIG_RTC_MC13XXX - use MC13783 or MC13892 RTC
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001003 CONFIG_RTC_MC146818 - use MC146818 RTC
wdenk1cb8e982003-03-06 21:55:29 +00001004 CONFIG_RTC_DS1307 - use Maxim, Inc. DS1307 RTC
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001005 CONFIG_RTC_DS1337 - use Maxim, Inc. DS1337 RTC
wdenk7f70e852003-05-20 14:25:27 +00001006 CONFIG_RTC_DS1338 - use Maxim, Inc. DS1338 RTC
wdenk3bac3512003-03-12 10:41:04 +00001007 CONFIG_RTC_DS164x - use Dallas DS164x RTC
Tor Krill9536dfc2008-03-15 15:40:26 +01001008 CONFIG_RTC_ISL1208 - use Intersil ISL1208 RTC
wdenk4c0d4c32004-06-09 17:34:58 +00001009 CONFIG_RTC_MAX6900 - use Maxim, Inc. MAX6900 RTC
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001010 CONFIG_SYS_RTC_DS1337_NOOSC - Turn off the OSC output for DS1337
Heiko Schocher71d19f32011-03-28 09:24:22 +02001011 CONFIG_SYS_RV3029_TCR - enable trickle charger on
1012 RV3029 RTC.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001013
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001014 Note that if the RTC uses I2C, then the I2C interface
1015 must also be configured. See I2C Support, below.
1016
Peter Tysere92739d2008-12-17 16:36:21 -06001017- GPIO Support:
1018 CONFIG_PCA953X - use NXP's PCA953X series I2C GPIO
1019 CONFIG_PCA953X_INFO - enable pca953x info command
1020
Chris Packham5dec49c2010-12-19 10:12:13 +00001021 The CONFIG_SYS_I2C_PCA953X_WIDTH option specifies a list of
1022 chip-ngpio pairs that tell the PCA953X driver the number of
1023 pins supported by a particular chip.
1024
Peter Tysere92739d2008-12-17 16:36:21 -06001025 Note that if the GPIO device uses I2C, then the I2C interface
1026 must also be configured. See I2C Support, below.
1027
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001028- Timestamp Support:
1029
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00001030 When CONFIG_TIMESTAMP is selected, the timestamp
1031 (date and time) of an image is printed by image
1032 commands like bootm or iminfo. This option is
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001033 automatically enabled when you select CONFIG_CMD_DATE .
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001034
Karl O. Pinc923c46f2012-08-16 06:20:15 +00001035- Partition Labels (disklabels) Supported:
1036 Zero or more of the following:
1037 CONFIG_MAC_PARTITION Apple's MacOS partition table.
1038 CONFIG_DOS_PARTITION MS Dos partition table, traditional on the
1039 Intel architecture, USB sticks, etc.
1040 CONFIG_ISO_PARTITION ISO partition table, used on CDROM etc.
1041 CONFIG_EFI_PARTITION GPT partition table, common when EFI is the
1042 bootloader. Note 2TB partition limit; see
1043 disk/part_efi.c
1044 CONFIG_MTD_PARTITIONS Memory Technology Device partition table.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001045
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01001046 If IDE or SCSI support is enabled (CONFIG_CMD_IDE or
1047 CONFIG_CMD_SCSI) you must configure support for at
Karl O. Pinc923c46f2012-08-16 06:20:15 +00001048 least one non-MTD partition type as well.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001049
1050- IDE Reset method:
wdenk4d13cba2004-03-14 14:09:05 +00001051 CONFIG_IDE_RESET_ROUTINE - this is defined in several
1052 board configurations files but used nowhere!
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001053
wdenk4d13cba2004-03-14 14:09:05 +00001054 CONFIG_IDE_RESET - is this is defined, IDE Reset will
1055 be performed by calling the function
1056 ide_set_reset(int reset)
1057 which has to be defined in a board specific file
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001058
1059- ATAPI Support:
1060 CONFIG_ATAPI
1061
1062 Set this to enable ATAPI support.
1063
wdenkc40b2952004-03-13 23:29:43 +00001064- LBA48 Support
1065 CONFIG_LBA48
1066
1067 Set this to enable support for disks larger than 137GB
Heiko Schocher4b142fe2009-12-03 11:21:21 +01001068 Also look at CONFIG_SYS_64BIT_LBA.
wdenkc40b2952004-03-13 23:29:43 +00001069 Whithout these , LBA48 support uses 32bit variables and will 'only'
1070 support disks up to 2.1TB.
1071
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001072 CONFIG_SYS_64BIT_LBA:
wdenkc40b2952004-03-13 23:29:43 +00001073 When enabled, makes the IDE subsystem use 64bit sector addresses.
1074 Default is 32bit.
1075
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001076- SCSI Support:
1077 At the moment only there is only support for the
1078 SYM53C8XX SCSI controller; define
1079 CONFIG_SCSI_SYM53C8XX to enable it.
1080
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001081 CONFIG_SYS_SCSI_MAX_LUN [8], CONFIG_SYS_SCSI_MAX_SCSI_ID [7] and
1082 CONFIG_SYS_SCSI_MAX_DEVICE [CONFIG_SYS_SCSI_MAX_SCSI_ID *
1083 CONFIG_SYS_SCSI_MAX_LUN] can be adjusted to define the
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001084 maximum numbers of LUNs, SCSI ID's and target
1085 devices.
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001086 CONFIG_SYS_SCSI_SYM53C8XX_CCF to fix clock timing (80Mhz)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001087
Stefan Reinauer447c0312012-10-29 05:23:48 +00001088 The environment variable 'scsidevs' is set to the number of
1089 SCSI devices found during the last scan.
1090
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001091- NETWORK Support (PCI):
wdenk682011f2003-06-03 23:54:09 +00001092 CONFIG_E1000
Kyle Moffettce5207e2011-10-18 11:05:29 +00001093 Support for Intel 8254x/8257x gigabit chips.
1094
1095 CONFIG_E1000_SPI
1096 Utility code for direct access to the SPI bus on Intel 8257x.
1097 This does not do anything useful unless you set at least one
1098 of CONFIG_CMD_E1000 or CONFIG_E1000_SPI_GENERIC.
1099
1100 CONFIG_E1000_SPI_GENERIC
1101 Allow generic access to the SPI bus on the Intel 8257x, for
1102 example with the "sspi" command.
1103
1104 CONFIG_CMD_E1000
1105 Management command for E1000 devices. When used on devices
1106 with SPI support you can reprogram the EEPROM from U-Boot.
stroese53cf9432003-06-05 15:39:44 +00001107
Andre Schwarzac3315c2008-03-06 16:45:44 +01001108 CONFIG_E1000_FALLBACK_MAC
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001109 default MAC for empty EEPROM after production.
Andre Schwarzac3315c2008-03-06 16:45:44 +01001110
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001111 CONFIG_EEPRO100
1112 Support for Intel 82557/82559/82559ER chips.
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001113 Optional CONFIG_EEPRO100_SROM_WRITE enables EEPROM
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001114 write routine for first time initialisation.
1115
1116 CONFIG_TULIP
1117 Support for Digital 2114x chips.
1118 Optional CONFIG_TULIP_SELECT_MEDIA for board specific
1119 modem chip initialisation (KS8761/QS6611).
1120
1121 CONFIG_NATSEMI
1122 Support for National dp83815 chips.
1123
1124 CONFIG_NS8382X
1125 Support for National dp8382[01] gigabit chips.
1126
wdenk45219c42003-05-12 21:50:16 +00001127- NETWORK Support (other):
1128
Jens Scharsigc041e9d2010-01-23 12:03:45 +01001129 CONFIG_DRIVER_AT91EMAC
1130 Support for AT91RM9200 EMAC.
1131
1132 CONFIG_RMII
1133 Define this to use reduced MII inteface
1134
1135 CONFIG_DRIVER_AT91EMAC_QUIET
1136 If this defined, the driver is quiet.
1137 The driver doen't show link status messages.
1138
Rob Herringefdd7312011-12-15 11:15:49 +00001139 CONFIG_CALXEDA_XGMAC
1140 Support for the Calxeda XGMAC device
1141
Ashok3bb46d22012-10-15 06:20:47 +00001142 CONFIG_LAN91C96
wdenk45219c42003-05-12 21:50:16 +00001143 Support for SMSC's LAN91C96 chips.
1144
1145 CONFIG_LAN91C96_BASE
1146 Define this to hold the physical address
1147 of the LAN91C96's I/O space
1148
1149 CONFIG_LAN91C96_USE_32_BIT
1150 Define this to enable 32 bit addressing
1151
Ashok3bb46d22012-10-15 06:20:47 +00001152 CONFIG_SMC91111
wdenkf39748a2004-06-09 13:37:52 +00001153 Support for SMSC's LAN91C111 chip
1154
1155 CONFIG_SMC91111_BASE
1156 Define this to hold the physical address
1157 of the device (I/O space)
1158
1159 CONFIG_SMC_USE_32_BIT
1160 Define this if data bus is 32 bits
1161
1162 CONFIG_SMC_USE_IOFUNCS
1163 Define this to use i/o functions instead of macros
1164 (some hardware wont work with macros)
1165
Heiko Schocherdc02bad2011-11-15 10:00:04 -05001166 CONFIG_DRIVER_TI_EMAC
1167 Support for davinci emac
1168
1169 CONFIG_SYS_DAVINCI_EMAC_PHY_COUNT
1170 Define this if you have more then 3 PHYs.
1171
Macpaul Linb3dbf4a52010-12-21 16:59:46 +08001172 CONFIG_FTGMAC100
1173 Support for Faraday's FTGMAC100 Gigabit SoC Ethernet
1174
1175 CONFIG_FTGMAC100_EGIGA
1176 Define this to use GE link update with gigabit PHY.
1177 Define this if FTGMAC100 is connected to gigabit PHY.
1178 If your system has 10/100 PHY only, it might not occur
1179 wrong behavior. Because PHY usually return timeout or
1180 useless data when polling gigabit status and gigabit
1181 control registers. This behavior won't affect the
1182 correctnessof 10/100 link speed update.
1183
Mike Rapoportc2fff332009-11-11 10:03:03 +02001184 CONFIG_SMC911X
Jens Gehrlein557b3772008-05-05 14:06:11 +02001185 Support for SMSC's LAN911x and LAN921x chips
1186
Mike Rapoportc2fff332009-11-11 10:03:03 +02001187 CONFIG_SMC911X_BASE
Jens Gehrlein557b3772008-05-05 14:06:11 +02001188 Define this to hold the physical address
1189 of the device (I/O space)
1190
Mike Rapoportc2fff332009-11-11 10:03:03 +02001191 CONFIG_SMC911X_32_BIT
Jens Gehrlein557b3772008-05-05 14:06:11 +02001192 Define this if data bus is 32 bits
1193
Mike Rapoportc2fff332009-11-11 10:03:03 +02001194 CONFIG_SMC911X_16_BIT
Jens Gehrlein557b3772008-05-05 14:06:11 +02001195 Define this if data bus is 16 bits. If your processor
1196 automatically converts one 32 bit word to two 16 bit
Mike Rapoportc2fff332009-11-11 10:03:03 +02001197 words you may also try CONFIG_SMC911X_32_BIT.
Jens Gehrlein557b3772008-05-05 14:06:11 +02001198
Yoshihiro Shimoda3d0075f2011-01-27 10:06:03 +09001199 CONFIG_SH_ETHER
1200 Support for Renesas on-chip Ethernet controller
1201
1202 CONFIG_SH_ETHER_USE_PORT
1203 Define the number of ports to be used
1204
1205 CONFIG_SH_ETHER_PHY_ADDR
1206 Define the ETH PHY's address
1207
Yoshihiro Shimoda68260aa2011-01-27 10:06:08 +09001208 CONFIG_SH_ETHER_CACHE_WRITEBACK
1209 If this option is set, the driver enables cache flush.
1210
Vadim Bendebury5e124722011-10-17 08:36:14 +00001211- TPM Support:
1212 CONFIG_GENERIC_LPC_TPM
1213 Support for generic parallel port TPM devices. Only one device
1214 per system is supported at this time.
1215
1216 CONFIG_TPM_TIS_BASE_ADDRESS
1217 Base address where the generic TPM device is mapped
1218 to. Contemporary x86 systems usually map it at
1219 0xfed40000.
1220
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001221- USB Support:
1222 At the moment only the UHCI host controller is
wdenk4d13cba2004-03-14 14:09:05 +00001223 supported (PIP405, MIP405, MPC5200); define
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001224 CONFIG_USB_UHCI to enable it.
1225 define CONFIG_USB_KEYBOARD to enable the USB Keyboard
wdenk30d56fa2004-10-09 22:44:59 +00001226 and define CONFIG_USB_STORAGE to enable the USB
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001227 storage devices.
1228 Note:
1229 Supported are USB Keyboards and USB Floppy drives
1230 (TEAC FD-05PUB).
wdenk4d13cba2004-03-14 14:09:05 +00001231 MPC5200 USB requires additional defines:
1232 CONFIG_USB_CLOCK
1233 for 528 MHz Clock: 0x0001bbbb
Eric Millbrandt307ecb62009-08-13 08:32:37 -05001234 CONFIG_PSC3_USB
1235 for USB on PSC3
wdenk4d13cba2004-03-14 14:09:05 +00001236 CONFIG_USB_CONFIG
1237 for differential drivers: 0x00001000
1238 for single ended drivers: 0x00005000
Eric Millbrandt307ecb62009-08-13 08:32:37 -05001239 for differential drivers on PSC3: 0x00000100
1240 for single ended drivers on PSC3: 0x00004100
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001241 CONFIG_SYS_USB_EVENT_POLL
Zhang Weifdcfaa12007-06-06 10:08:13 +02001242 May be defined to allow interrupt polling
1243 instead of using asynchronous interrupts
wdenk4d13cba2004-03-14 14:09:05 +00001244
Simon Glass9ab4ce22012-02-27 10:52:47 +00001245 CONFIG_USB_EHCI_TXFIFO_THRESH enables setting of the
1246 txfilltuning field in the EHCI controller on reset.
1247
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001248- USB Device:
1249 Define the below if you wish to use the USB console.
1250 Once firmware is rebuilt from a serial console issue the
1251 command "setenv stdin usbtty; setenv stdout usbtty" and
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001252 attach your USB cable. The Unix command "dmesg" should print
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001253 it has found a new device. The environment variable usbtty
1254 can be set to gserial or cdc_acm to enable your device to
Wolfgang Denk386eda02006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001255 appear to a USB host as a Linux gserial device or a
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001256 Common Device Class Abstract Control Model serial device.
1257 If you select usbtty = gserial you should be able to enumerate
1258 a Linux host by
1259 # modprobe usbserial vendor=0xVendorID product=0xProductID
1260 else if using cdc_acm, simply setting the environment
1261 variable usbtty to be cdc_acm should suffice. The following
1262 might be defined in YourBoardName.h
Wolfgang Denk386eda02006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001263
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001264 CONFIG_USB_DEVICE
1265 Define this to build a UDC device
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001266
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001267 CONFIG_USB_TTY
1268 Define this to have a tty type of device available to
1269 talk to the UDC device
Wolfgang Denk386eda02006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001270
Vipin KUMARf9da0f82012-03-26 15:38:06 +05301271 CONFIG_USBD_HS
1272 Define this to enable the high speed support for usb
1273 device and usbtty. If this feature is enabled, a routine
1274 int is_usbd_high_speed(void)
1275 also needs to be defined by the driver to dynamically poll
1276 whether the enumeration has succeded at high speed or full
1277 speed.
1278
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001279 CONFIG_SYS_CONSOLE_IS_IN_ENV
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001280 Define this if you want stdin, stdout &/or stderr to
1281 be set to usbtty.
1282
1283 mpc8xx:
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001284 CONFIG_SYS_USB_EXTC_CLK 0xBLAH
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001285 Derive USB clock from external clock "blah"
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001286 - CONFIG_SYS_USB_EXTC_CLK 0x02
Wolfgang Denk386eda02006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001287
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001288 CONFIG_SYS_USB_BRG_CLK 0xBLAH
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001289 Derive USB clock from brgclk
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001290 - CONFIG_SYS_USB_BRG_CLK 0x04
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001291
Wolfgang Denk386eda02006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001292 If you have a USB-IF assigned VendorID then you may wish to
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001293 define your own vendor specific values either in BoardName.h
Wolfgang Denk386eda02006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001294 or directly in usbd_vendor_info.h. If you don't define
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001295 CONFIG_USBD_MANUFACTURER, CONFIG_USBD_PRODUCT_NAME,
1296 CONFIG_USBD_VENDORID and CONFIG_USBD_PRODUCTID, then U-Boot
1297 should pretend to be a Linux device to it's target host.
1298
1299 CONFIG_USBD_MANUFACTURER
1300 Define this string as the name of your company for
1301 - CONFIG_USBD_MANUFACTURER "my company"
Wolfgang Denk386eda02006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001302
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001303 CONFIG_USBD_PRODUCT_NAME
1304 Define this string as the name of your product
1305 - CONFIG_USBD_PRODUCT_NAME "acme usb device"
1306
1307 CONFIG_USBD_VENDORID
1308 Define this as your assigned Vendor ID from the USB
1309 Implementors Forum. This *must* be a genuine Vendor ID
1310 to avoid polluting the USB namespace.
1311 - CONFIG_USBD_VENDORID 0xFFFF
Wolfgang Denk386eda02006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001312
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001313 CONFIG_USBD_PRODUCTID
1314 Define this as the unique Product ID
1315 for your device
1316 - CONFIG_USBD_PRODUCTID 0xFFFF
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001317
Igor Grinbergd70a5602011-12-12 12:08:35 +02001318- ULPI Layer Support:
1319 The ULPI (UTMI Low Pin (count) Interface) PHYs are supported via
1320 the generic ULPI layer. The generic layer accesses the ULPI PHY
1321 via the platform viewport, so you need both the genric layer and
1322 the viewport enabled. Currently only Chipidea/ARC based
1323 viewport is supported.
1324 To enable the ULPI layer support, define CONFIG_USB_ULPI and
1325 CONFIG_USB_ULPI_VIEWPORT in your board configuration file.
Lucas Stach6d365ea2012-10-01 00:44:35 +02001326 If your ULPI phy needs a different reference clock than the
1327 standard 24 MHz then you have to define CONFIG_ULPI_REF_CLK to
1328 the appropriate value in Hz.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001329
1330- MMC Support:
1331 The MMC controller on the Intel PXA is supported. To
1332 enable this define CONFIG_MMC. The MMC can be
1333 accessed from the boot prompt by mapping the device
1334 to physical memory similar to flash. Command line is
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001335 enabled with CONFIG_CMD_MMC. The MMC driver also works with
1336 the FAT fs. This is enabled with CONFIG_CMD_FAT.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001337
Yoshihiro Shimodaafb35662011-07-04 22:21:22 +00001338 CONFIG_SH_MMCIF
1339 Support for Renesas on-chip MMCIF controller
1340
1341 CONFIG_SH_MMCIF_ADDR
1342 Define the base address of MMCIF registers
1343
1344 CONFIG_SH_MMCIF_CLK
1345 Define the clock frequency for MMCIF
1346
Tom Rinib3ba6e92013-03-14 05:32:47 +00001347- USB Device Firmware Update (DFU) class support:
1348 CONFIG_DFU_FUNCTION
1349 This enables the USB portion of the DFU USB class
1350
1351 CONFIG_CMD_DFU
1352 This enables the command "dfu" which is used to have
1353 U-Boot create a DFU class device via USB. This command
1354 requires that the "dfu_alt_info" environment variable be
1355 set and define the alt settings to expose to the host.
1356
1357 CONFIG_DFU_MMC
1358 This enables support for exposing (e)MMC devices via DFU.
1359
Pantelis Antoniouea2453d2013-03-14 05:32:48 +00001360 CONFIG_SYS_DFU_MAX_FILE_SIZE
1361 When updating files rather than the raw storage device,
1362 we use a static buffer to copy the file into and then write
1363 the buffer once we've been given the whole file. Define
1364 this to the maximum filesize (in bytes) for the buffer.
1365 Default is 4 MiB if undefined.
1366
wdenk6705d812004-08-02 23:22:59 +00001367- Journaling Flash filesystem support:
1368 CONFIG_JFFS2_NAND, CONFIG_JFFS2_NAND_OFF, CONFIG_JFFS2_NAND_SIZE,
1369 CONFIG_JFFS2_NAND_DEV
1370 Define these for a default partition on a NAND device
1371
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001372 CONFIG_SYS_JFFS2_FIRST_SECTOR,
1373 CONFIG_SYS_JFFS2_FIRST_BANK, CONFIG_SYS_JFFS2_NUM_BANKS
wdenk6705d812004-08-02 23:22:59 +00001374 Define these for a default partition on a NOR device
1375
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001376 CONFIG_SYS_JFFS_CUSTOM_PART
wdenk6705d812004-08-02 23:22:59 +00001377 Define this to create an own partition. You have to provide a
1378 function struct part_info* jffs2_part_info(int part_num)
1379
1380 If you define only one JFFS2 partition you may also want to
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001381 #define CONFIG_SYS_JFFS_SINGLE_PART 1
wdenk6705d812004-08-02 23:22:59 +00001382 to disable the command chpart. This is the default when you
1383 have not defined a custom partition
1384
Donggeun Kimc30a15e2011-10-24 21:15:28 +00001385- FAT(File Allocation Table) filesystem write function support:
1386 CONFIG_FAT_WRITE
Donggeun Kim656f4c62012-03-22 04:38:56 +00001387
1388 Define this to enable support for saving memory data as a
1389 file in FAT formatted partition.
1390
1391 This will also enable the command "fatwrite" enabling the
1392 user to write files to FAT.
Donggeun Kimc30a15e2011-10-24 21:15:28 +00001393
Gabe Black84cd9322012-10-12 14:26:11 +00001394CBFS (Coreboot Filesystem) support
1395 CONFIG_CMD_CBFS
1396
1397 Define this to enable support for reading from a Coreboot
1398 filesystem. Available commands are cbfsinit, cbfsinfo, cbfsls
1399 and cbfsload.
1400
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001401- Keyboard Support:
1402 CONFIG_ISA_KEYBOARD
1403
1404 Define this to enable standard (PC-Style) keyboard
1405 support
1406
1407 CONFIG_I8042_KBD
1408 Standard PC keyboard driver with US (is default) and
1409 GERMAN key layout (switch via environment 'keymap=de') support.
1410 Export function i8042_kbd_init, i8042_tstc and i8042_getc
1411 for cfb_console. Supports cursor blinking.
1412
1413- Video support:
1414 CONFIG_VIDEO
1415
1416 Define this to enable video support (for output to
1417 video).
1418
1419 CONFIG_VIDEO_CT69000
1420
1421 Enable Chips & Technologies 69000 Video chip
1422
1423 CONFIG_VIDEO_SMI_LYNXEM
wdenkb79a11c2004-03-25 15:14:43 +00001424 Enable Silicon Motion SMI 712/710/810 Video chip. The
wdenkeeb1b772004-03-23 22:53:55 +00001425 video output is selected via environment 'videoout'
1426 (1 = LCD and 2 = CRT). If videoout is undefined, CRT is
1427 assumed.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001428
wdenkb79a11c2004-03-25 15:14:43 +00001429 For the CT69000 and SMI_LYNXEM drivers, videomode is
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001430 selected via environment 'videomode'. Two different ways
wdenkeeb1b772004-03-23 22:53:55 +00001431 are possible:
1432 - "videomode=num" 'num' is a standard LiLo mode numbers.
wdenk6e592382004-04-18 17:39:38 +00001433 Following standard modes are supported (* is default):
wdenkeeb1b772004-03-23 22:53:55 +00001434
1435 Colors 640x480 800x600 1024x768 1152x864 1280x1024
1436 -------------+---------------------------------------------
1437 8 bits | 0x301* 0x303 0x305 0x161 0x307
1438 15 bits | 0x310 0x313 0x316 0x162 0x319
1439 16 bits | 0x311 0x314 0x317 0x163 0x31A
1440 24 bits | 0x312 0x315 0x318 ? 0x31B
1441 -------------+---------------------------------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001442 (i.e. setenv videomode 317; saveenv; reset;)
1443
wdenkb79a11c2004-03-25 15:14:43 +00001444 - "videomode=bootargs" all the video parameters are parsed
Marcel Ziswiler7817cb22007-12-30 03:30:46 +01001445 from the bootargs. (See drivers/video/videomodes.c)
wdenkeeb1b772004-03-23 22:53:55 +00001446
1447
stroesec1551ea2003-04-04 15:53:41 +00001448 CONFIG_VIDEO_SED13806
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00001449 Enable Epson SED13806 driver. This driver supports 8bpp
wdenka6c7ad22002-12-03 21:28:10 +00001450 and 16bpp modes defined by CONFIG_VIDEO_SED13806_8BPP
1451 or CONFIG_VIDEO_SED13806_16BPP
1452
Timur Tabi7d3053f2011-02-15 17:09:19 -06001453 CONFIG_FSL_DIU_FB
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02001454 Enable the Freescale DIU video driver. Reference boards for
Timur Tabi7d3053f2011-02-15 17:09:19 -06001455 SOCs that have a DIU should define this macro to enable DIU
1456 support, and should also define these other macros:
1457
1458 CONFIG_SYS_DIU_ADDR
1459 CONFIG_VIDEO
1460 CONFIG_CMD_BMP
1461 CONFIG_CFB_CONSOLE
1462 CONFIG_VIDEO_SW_CURSOR
1463 CONFIG_VGA_AS_SINGLE_DEVICE
1464 CONFIG_VIDEO_LOGO
1465 CONFIG_VIDEO_BMP_LOGO
1466
Timur Tabiba8e76b2011-04-11 14:18:22 -05001467 The DIU driver will look for the 'video-mode' environment
1468 variable, and if defined, enable the DIU as a console during
1469 boot. See the documentation file README.video for a
1470 description of this variable.
Timur Tabi7d3053f2011-02-15 17:09:19 -06001471
Simon Glass058d59b2012-12-03 13:59:47 +00001472 CONFIG_VIDEO_VGA
1473
1474 Enable the VGA video / BIOS for x86. The alternative if you
1475 are using coreboot is to use the coreboot frame buffer
1476 driver.
1477
1478
wdenk682011f2003-06-03 23:54:09 +00001479- Keyboard Support:
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00001480 CONFIG_KEYBOARD
wdenk682011f2003-06-03 23:54:09 +00001481
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00001482 Define this to enable a custom keyboard support.
1483 This simply calls drv_keyboard_init() which must be
1484 defined in your board-specific files.
1485 The only board using this so far is RBC823.
wdenka6c7ad22002-12-03 21:28:10 +00001486
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001487- LCD Support: CONFIG_LCD
1488
1489 Define this to enable LCD support (for output to LCD
1490 display); also select one of the supported displays
1491 by defining one of these:
1492
Stelian Pop39cf4802008-05-09 21:57:18 +02001493 CONFIG_ATMEL_LCD:
1494
1495 HITACHI TX09D70VM1CCA, 3.5", 240x320.
1496
wdenkfd3103b2003-11-25 16:55:19 +00001497 CONFIG_NEC_NL6448AC33:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001498
wdenkfd3103b2003-11-25 16:55:19 +00001499 NEC NL6448AC33-18. Active, color, single scan.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001500
wdenkfd3103b2003-11-25 16:55:19 +00001501 CONFIG_NEC_NL6448BC20
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001502
wdenkfd3103b2003-11-25 16:55:19 +00001503 NEC NL6448BC20-08. 6.5", 640x480.
1504 Active, color, single scan.
1505
1506 CONFIG_NEC_NL6448BC33_54
1507
1508 NEC NL6448BC33-54. 10.4", 640x480.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001509 Active, color, single scan.
1510
1511 CONFIG_SHARP_16x9
1512
1513 Sharp 320x240. Active, color, single scan.
1514 It isn't 16x9, and I am not sure what it is.
1515
1516 CONFIG_SHARP_LQ64D341
1517
1518 Sharp LQ64D341 display, 640x480.
1519 Active, color, single scan.
1520
1521 CONFIG_HLD1045
1522
1523 HLD1045 display, 640x480.
1524 Active, color, single scan.
1525
1526 CONFIG_OPTREX_BW
1527
1528 Optrex CBL50840-2 NF-FW 99 22 M5
1529 or
1530 Hitachi LMG6912RPFC-00T
1531 or
1532 Hitachi SP14Q002
1533
1534 320x240. Black & white.
1535
1536 Normally display is black on white background; define
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001537 CONFIG_SYS_WHITE_ON_BLACK to get it inverted.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001538
Simon Glass676d3192012-10-17 13:24:54 +00001539 CONFIG_LCD_ALIGNMENT
1540
1541 Normally the LCD is page-aligned (tyically 4KB). If this is
1542 defined then the LCD will be aligned to this value instead.
1543 For ARM it is sometimes useful to use MMU_SECTION_SIZE
1544 here, since it is cheaper to change data cache settings on
1545 a per-section basis.
1546
Simon Glass0d89efe2012-10-17 13:24:59 +00001547 CONFIG_CONSOLE_SCROLL_LINES
1548
1549 When the console need to be scrolled, this is the number of
1550 lines to scroll by. It defaults to 1. Increasing this makes
1551 the console jump but can help speed up operation when scrolling
1552 is slow.
Simon Glass676d3192012-10-17 13:24:54 +00001553
Tom Wai-Hong Tam45d7f522012-09-28 15:11:16 +00001554 CONFIG_LCD_BMP_RLE8
1555
1556 Support drawing of RLE8-compressed bitmaps on the LCD.
1557
Tom Wai-Hong Tam735987c2012-12-05 14:46:40 +00001558 CONFIG_I2C_EDID
1559
1560 Enables an 'i2c edid' command which can read EDID
1561 information over I2C from an attached LCD display.
1562
wdenk7152b1d2003-09-05 23:19:14 +00001563- Splash Screen Support: CONFIG_SPLASH_SCREEN
wdenkd791b1d2003-04-20 14:04:18 +00001564
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00001565 If this option is set, the environment is checked for
1566 a variable "splashimage". If found, the usual display
1567 of logo, copyright and system information on the LCD
wdenke94d2cd2004-06-30 22:59:18 +00001568 is suppressed and the BMP image at the address
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00001569 specified in "splashimage" is loaded instead. The
1570 console is redirected to the "nulldev", too. This
1571 allows for a "silent" boot where a splash screen is
1572 loaded very quickly after power-on.
wdenkd791b1d2003-04-20 14:04:18 +00001573
Nikita Kiryanovc0880482013-02-24 21:28:43 +00001574 CONFIG_SPLASHIMAGE_GUARD
1575
1576 If this option is set, then U-Boot will prevent the environment
1577 variable "splashimage" from being set to a problematic address
1578 (see README.displaying-bmps and README.arm-unaligned-accesses).
1579 This option is useful for targets where, due to alignment
1580 restrictions, an improperly aligned BMP image will cause a data
1581 abort. If you think you will not have problems with unaligned
1582 accesses (for example because your toolchain prevents them)
1583 there is no need to set this option.
1584
Matthias Weisser1ca298c2009-07-09 16:07:30 +02001585 CONFIG_SPLASH_SCREEN_ALIGN
1586
1587 If this option is set the splash image can be freely positioned
1588 on the screen. Environment variable "splashpos" specifies the
1589 position as "x,y". If a positive number is given it is used as
1590 number of pixel from left/top. If a negative number is given it
1591 is used as number of pixel from right/bottom. You can also
1592 specify 'm' for centering the image.
1593
1594 Example:
1595 setenv splashpos m,m
1596 => image at center of screen
1597
1598 setenv splashpos 30,20
1599 => image at x = 30 and y = 20
1600
1601 setenv splashpos -10,m
1602 => vertically centered image
1603 at x = dspWidth - bmpWidth - 9
1604
Nikita Kiryanov581bb412013-01-30 21:39:57 +00001605 CONFIG_SPLASH_SCREEN_PREPARE
1606
1607 If this option is set then the board_splash_screen_prepare()
1608 function, which must be defined in your code, is called as part
1609 of the splash screen display sequence. It gives the board an
1610 opportunity to prepare the splash image data before it is
1611 processed and sent to the frame buffer by U-Boot.
1612
Stefan Roese98f4a3d2005-09-22 09:04:17 +02001613- Gzip compressed BMP image support: CONFIG_VIDEO_BMP_GZIP
1614
1615 If this option is set, additionally to standard BMP
1616 images, gzipped BMP images can be displayed via the
1617 splashscreen support or the bmp command.
1618
Anatolij Gustschind5011762010-03-15 14:50:25 +01001619- Run length encoded BMP image (RLE8) support: CONFIG_VIDEO_BMP_RLE8
1620
1621 If this option is set, 8-bit RLE compressed BMP images
1622 can be displayed via the splashscreen support or the
1623 bmp command.
1624
Lei Wenf2b96df2012-09-28 04:26:47 +00001625- Do compresssing for memory range:
1626 CONFIG_CMD_ZIP
1627
1628 If this option is set, it would use zlib deflate method
1629 to compress the specified memory at its best effort.
1630
wdenkc29fdfc2003-08-29 20:57:53 +00001631- Compression support:
1632 CONFIG_BZIP2
1633
1634 If this option is set, support for bzip2 compressed
1635 images is included. If not, only uncompressed and gzip
1636 compressed images are supported.
1637
wdenk42d1f032003-10-15 23:53:47 +00001638 NOTE: the bzip2 algorithm requires a lot of RAM, so
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001639 the malloc area (as defined by CONFIG_SYS_MALLOC_LEN) should
wdenk42d1f032003-10-15 23:53:47 +00001640 be at least 4MB.
wdenkd791b1d2003-04-20 14:04:18 +00001641
Luigi 'Comio' Mantellinifc9c1722008-09-08 02:46:13 +02001642 CONFIG_LZMA
1643
1644 If this option is set, support for lzma compressed
1645 images is included.
1646
1647 Note: The LZMA algorithm adds between 2 and 4KB of code and it
1648 requires an amount of dynamic memory that is given by the
1649 formula:
1650
1651 (1846 + 768 << (lc + lp)) * sizeof(uint16)
1652
1653 Where lc and lp stand for, respectively, Literal context bits
1654 and Literal pos bits.
1655
1656 This value is upper-bounded by 14MB in the worst case. Anyway,
1657 for a ~4MB large kernel image, we have lc=3 and lp=0 for a
1658 total amount of (1846 + 768 << (3 + 0)) * 2 = ~41KB... that is
1659 a very small buffer.
1660
1661 Use the lzmainfo tool to determinate the lc and lp values and
1662 then calculate the amount of needed dynamic memory (ensuring
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001663 the appropriate CONFIG_SYS_MALLOC_LEN value).
Luigi 'Comio' Mantellinifc9c1722008-09-08 02:46:13 +02001664
wdenk17ea1172004-06-06 21:51:03 +00001665- MII/PHY support:
1666 CONFIG_PHY_ADDR
1667
1668 The address of PHY on MII bus.
1669
1670 CONFIG_PHY_CLOCK_FREQ (ppc4xx)
1671
1672 The clock frequency of the MII bus
1673
1674 CONFIG_PHY_GIGE
1675
1676 If this option is set, support for speed/duplex
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001677 detection of gigabit PHY is included.
wdenk17ea1172004-06-06 21:51:03 +00001678
1679 CONFIG_PHY_RESET_DELAY
1680
1681 Some PHY like Intel LXT971A need extra delay after
1682 reset before any MII register access is possible.
1683 For such PHY, set this option to the usec delay
1684 required. (minimum 300usec for LXT971A)
1685
1686 CONFIG_PHY_CMD_DELAY (ppc4xx)
1687
1688 Some PHY like Intel LXT971A need extra delay after
1689 command issued before MII status register can be read
1690
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001691- Ethernet address:
1692 CONFIG_ETHADDR
richardretanubunc68a05f2008-09-29 18:28:23 -04001693 CONFIG_ETH1ADDR
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001694 CONFIG_ETH2ADDR
1695 CONFIG_ETH3ADDR
richardretanubunc68a05f2008-09-29 18:28:23 -04001696 CONFIG_ETH4ADDR
1697 CONFIG_ETH5ADDR
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001698
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001699 Define a default value for Ethernet address to use
1700 for the respective Ethernet interface, in case this
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001701 is not determined automatically.
1702
1703- IP address:
1704 CONFIG_IPADDR
1705
1706 Define a default value for the IP address to use for
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001707 the default Ethernet interface, in case this is not
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001708 determined through e.g. bootp.
Wolfgang Denk1ebcd652011-10-26 10:21:22 +00001709 (Environment variable "ipaddr")
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001710
1711- Server IP address:
1712 CONFIG_SERVERIP
1713
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001714 Defines a default value for the IP address of a TFTP
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001715 server to contact when using the "tftboot" command.
Wolfgang Denk1ebcd652011-10-26 10:21:22 +00001716 (Environment variable "serverip")
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001717
Robin Getz97cfe862009-07-21 12:15:28 -04001718 CONFIG_KEEP_SERVERADDR
1719
1720 Keeps the server's MAC address, in the env 'serveraddr'
1721 for passing to bootargs (like Linux's netconsole option)
1722
Wolfgang Denk1ebcd652011-10-26 10:21:22 +00001723- Gateway IP address:
1724 CONFIG_GATEWAYIP
1725
1726 Defines a default value for the IP address of the
1727 default router where packets to other networks are
1728 sent to.
1729 (Environment variable "gatewayip")
1730
1731- Subnet mask:
1732 CONFIG_NETMASK
1733
1734 Defines a default value for the subnet mask (or
1735 routing prefix) which is used to determine if an IP
1736 address belongs to the local subnet or needs to be
1737 forwarded through a router.
1738 (Environment variable "netmask")
1739
David Updegraff53a5c422007-06-11 10:41:07 -05001740- Multicast TFTP Mode:
1741 CONFIG_MCAST_TFTP
1742
1743 Defines whether you want to support multicast TFTP as per
1744 rfc-2090; for example to work with atftp. Lets lots of targets
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001745 tftp down the same boot image concurrently. Note: the Ethernet
David Updegraff53a5c422007-06-11 10:41:07 -05001746 driver in use must provide a function: mcast() to join/leave a
1747 multicast group.
1748
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001749- BOOTP Recovery Mode:
1750 CONFIG_BOOTP_RANDOM_DELAY
1751
1752 If you have many targets in a network that try to
1753 boot using BOOTP, you may want to avoid that all
1754 systems send out BOOTP requests at precisely the same
1755 moment (which would happen for instance at recovery
1756 from a power failure, when all systems will try to
1757 boot, thus flooding the BOOTP server. Defining
1758 CONFIG_BOOTP_RANDOM_DELAY causes a random delay to be
1759 inserted before sending out BOOTP requests. The
Wolfgang Denk6c33c782007-08-06 23:21:05 +02001760 following delays are inserted then:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001761
1762 1st BOOTP request: delay 0 ... 1 sec
1763 2nd BOOTP request: delay 0 ... 2 sec
1764 3rd BOOTP request: delay 0 ... 4 sec
1765 4th and following
1766 BOOTP requests: delay 0 ... 8 sec
1767
stroesefe389a82003-08-28 14:17:32 +00001768- DHCP Advanced Options:
Jon Loeliger1fe80d72007-07-09 22:08:34 -05001769 You can fine tune the DHCP functionality by defining
1770 CONFIG_BOOTP_* symbols:
stroesefe389a82003-08-28 14:17:32 +00001771
Jon Loeliger1fe80d72007-07-09 22:08:34 -05001772 CONFIG_BOOTP_SUBNETMASK
1773 CONFIG_BOOTP_GATEWAY
1774 CONFIG_BOOTP_HOSTNAME
1775 CONFIG_BOOTP_NISDOMAIN
1776 CONFIG_BOOTP_BOOTPATH
1777 CONFIG_BOOTP_BOOTFILESIZE
1778 CONFIG_BOOTP_DNS
1779 CONFIG_BOOTP_DNS2
1780 CONFIG_BOOTP_SEND_HOSTNAME
1781 CONFIG_BOOTP_NTPSERVER
1782 CONFIG_BOOTP_TIMEOFFSET
1783 CONFIG_BOOTP_VENDOREX
Joe Hershberger2c00e092012-05-23 07:59:19 +00001784 CONFIG_BOOTP_MAY_FAIL
stroesefe389a82003-08-28 14:17:32 +00001785
Wilson Callan5d110f02007-07-28 10:56:13 -04001786 CONFIG_BOOTP_SERVERIP - TFTP server will be the serverip
1787 environment variable, not the BOOTP server.
stroesefe389a82003-08-28 14:17:32 +00001788
Joe Hershberger2c00e092012-05-23 07:59:19 +00001789 CONFIG_BOOTP_MAY_FAIL - If the DHCP server is not found
1790 after the configured retry count, the call will fail
1791 instead of starting over. This can be used to fail over
1792 to Link-local IP address configuration if the DHCP server
1793 is not available.
1794
stroesefe389a82003-08-28 14:17:32 +00001795 CONFIG_BOOTP_DNS2 - If a DHCP client requests the DNS
1796 serverip from a DHCP server, it is possible that more
1797 than one DNS serverip is offered to the client.
1798 If CONFIG_BOOTP_DNS2 is enabled, the secondary DNS
1799 serverip will be stored in the additional environment
1800 variable "dnsip2". The first DNS serverip is always
1801 stored in the variable "dnsip", when CONFIG_BOOTP_DNS
Jon Loeliger1fe80d72007-07-09 22:08:34 -05001802 is defined.
stroesefe389a82003-08-28 14:17:32 +00001803
1804 CONFIG_BOOTP_SEND_HOSTNAME - Some DHCP servers are capable
1805 to do a dynamic update of a DNS server. To do this, they
1806 need the hostname of the DHCP requester.
Wilson Callan5d110f02007-07-28 10:56:13 -04001807 If CONFIG_BOOTP_SEND_HOSTNAME is defined, the content
Jon Loeliger1fe80d72007-07-09 22:08:34 -05001808 of the "hostname" environment variable is passed as
1809 option 12 to the DHCP server.
stroesefe389a82003-08-28 14:17:32 +00001810
Aras Vaichasd9a2f412008-03-26 09:43:57 +11001811 CONFIG_BOOTP_DHCP_REQUEST_DELAY
1812
1813 A 32bit value in microseconds for a delay between
1814 receiving a "DHCP Offer" and sending the "DHCP Request".
1815 This fixes a problem with certain DHCP servers that don't
1816 respond 100% of the time to a "DHCP request". E.g. On an
1817 AT91RM9200 processor running at 180MHz, this delay needed
1818 to be *at least* 15,000 usec before a Windows Server 2003
1819 DHCP server would reply 100% of the time. I recommend at
1820 least 50,000 usec to be safe. The alternative is to hope
1821 that one of the retries will be successful but note that
1822 the DHCP timeout and retry process takes a longer than
1823 this delay.
1824
Joe Hershbergerd22c3382012-05-23 08:00:12 +00001825 - Link-local IP address negotiation:
1826 Negotiate with other link-local clients on the local network
1827 for an address that doesn't require explicit configuration.
1828 This is especially useful if a DHCP server cannot be guaranteed
1829 to exist in all environments that the device must operate.
1830
1831 See doc/README.link-local for more information.
1832
wdenka3d991b2004-04-15 21:48:45 +00001833 - CDP Options:
wdenk6e592382004-04-18 17:39:38 +00001834 CONFIG_CDP_DEVICE_ID
wdenka3d991b2004-04-15 21:48:45 +00001835
1836 The device id used in CDP trigger frames.
1837
1838 CONFIG_CDP_DEVICE_ID_PREFIX
1839
1840 A two character string which is prefixed to the MAC address
1841 of the device.
1842
1843 CONFIG_CDP_PORT_ID
1844
1845 A printf format string which contains the ascii name of
1846 the port. Normally is set to "eth%d" which sets
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001847 eth0 for the first Ethernet, eth1 for the second etc.
wdenka3d991b2004-04-15 21:48:45 +00001848
1849 CONFIG_CDP_CAPABILITIES
1850
1851 A 32bit integer which indicates the device capabilities;
1852 0x00000010 for a normal host which does not forwards.
1853
1854 CONFIG_CDP_VERSION
1855
1856 An ascii string containing the version of the software.
1857
1858 CONFIG_CDP_PLATFORM
1859
1860 An ascii string containing the name of the platform.
1861
1862 CONFIG_CDP_TRIGGER
1863
1864 A 32bit integer sent on the trigger.
1865
1866 CONFIG_CDP_POWER_CONSUMPTION
1867
1868 A 16bit integer containing the power consumption of the
1869 device in .1 of milliwatts.
1870
1871 CONFIG_CDP_APPLIANCE_VLAN_TYPE
1872
1873 A byte containing the id of the VLAN.
1874
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001875- Status LED: CONFIG_STATUS_LED
1876
1877 Several configurations allow to display the current
1878 status using a LED. For instance, the LED will blink
1879 fast while running U-Boot code, stop blinking as
1880 soon as a reply to a BOOTP request was received, and
1881 start blinking slow once the Linux kernel is running
1882 (supported by a status LED driver in the Linux
1883 kernel). Defining CONFIG_STATUS_LED enables this
1884 feature in U-Boot.
1885
1886- CAN Support: CONFIG_CAN_DRIVER
1887
1888 Defining CONFIG_CAN_DRIVER enables CAN driver support
1889 on those systems that support this (optional)
1890 feature, like the TQM8xxL modules.
1891
1892- I2C Support: CONFIG_HARD_I2C | CONFIG_SOFT_I2C
1893
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001894 These enable I2C serial bus commands. Defining either of
wdenk945af8d2003-07-16 21:53:01 +00001895 (but not both of) CONFIG_HARD_I2C or CONFIG_SOFT_I2C will
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001896 include the appropriate I2C driver for the selected CPU.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001897
wdenk945af8d2003-07-16 21:53:01 +00001898 This will allow you to use i2c commands at the u-boot
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001899 command line (as long as you set CONFIG_CMD_I2C in
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001900 CONFIG_COMMANDS) and communicate with i2c based realtime
1901 clock chips. See common/cmd_i2c.c for a description of the
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00001902 command line interface.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001903
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04001904 CONFIG_HARD_I2C selects a hardware I2C controller.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001905
wdenk945af8d2003-07-16 21:53:01 +00001906 CONFIG_SOFT_I2C configures u-boot to use a software (aka
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001907 bit-banging) driver instead of CPM or similar hardware
1908 support for I2C.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001909
wdenk945af8d2003-07-16 21:53:01 +00001910 There are several other quantities that must also be
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001911 defined when you define CONFIG_HARD_I2C or CONFIG_SOFT_I2C.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001912
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001913 In both cases you will need to define CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SPEED
wdenk945af8d2003-07-16 21:53:01 +00001914 to be the frequency (in Hz) at which you wish your i2c bus
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001915 to run and CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SLAVE to be the address of this node (ie
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001916 the CPU's i2c node address).
wdenk945af8d2003-07-16 21:53:01 +00001917
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -05001918 Now, the u-boot i2c code for the mpc8xx
Stefan Roesea47a12b2010-04-15 16:07:28 +02001919 (arch/powerpc/cpu/mpc8xx/i2c.c) sets the CPU up as a master node
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -05001920 and so its address should therefore be cleared to 0 (See,
1921 eg, MPC823e User's Manual p.16-473). So, set
1922 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SLAVE to 0.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001923
Eric Millbrandt5da71ef2009-09-03 08:09:44 -05001924 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_INIT_MPC5XXX
1925
1926 When a board is reset during an i2c bus transfer
1927 chips might think that the current transfer is still
1928 in progress. Reset the slave devices by sending start
1929 commands until the slave device responds.
1930
wdenk945af8d2003-07-16 21:53:01 +00001931 That's all that's required for CONFIG_HARD_I2C.
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001932
1933 If you use the software i2c interface (CONFIG_SOFT_I2C)
1934 then the following macros need to be defined (examples are
1935 from include/configs/lwmon.h):
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001936
1937 I2C_INIT
1938
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001939 (Optional). Any commands necessary to enable the I2C
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00001940 controller or configure ports.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001941
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +00001942 eg: #define I2C_INIT (immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdir |= PB_SCL)
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001943
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001944 I2C_PORT
1945
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00001946 (Only for MPC8260 CPU). The I/O port to use (the code
1947 assumes both bits are on the same port). Valid values
1948 are 0..3 for ports A..D.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001949
1950 I2C_ACTIVE
1951
1952 The code necessary to make the I2C data line active
1953 (driven). If the data line is open collector, this
1954 define can be null.
1955
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001956 eg: #define I2C_ACTIVE (immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdir |= PB_SDA)
1957
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001958 I2C_TRISTATE
1959
1960 The code necessary to make the I2C data line tri-stated
1961 (inactive). If the data line is open collector, this
1962 define can be null.
1963
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001964 eg: #define I2C_TRISTATE (immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdir &= ~PB_SDA)
1965
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001966 I2C_READ
1967
York Sun472d5462013-04-01 11:29:11 -07001968 Code that returns true if the I2C data line is high,
1969 false if it is low.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001970
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001971 eg: #define I2C_READ ((immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdat & PB_SDA) != 0)
1972
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001973 I2C_SDA(bit)
1974
York Sun472d5462013-04-01 11:29:11 -07001975 If <bit> is true, sets the I2C data line high. If it
1976 is false, it clears it (low).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001977
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001978 eg: #define I2C_SDA(bit) \
wdenk2535d602003-07-17 23:16:40 +00001979 if(bit) immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdat |= PB_SDA; \
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +00001980 else immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdat &= ~PB_SDA
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001981
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001982 I2C_SCL(bit)
1983
York Sun472d5462013-04-01 11:29:11 -07001984 If <bit> is true, sets the I2C clock line high. If it
1985 is false, it clears it (low).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001986
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001987 eg: #define I2C_SCL(bit) \
wdenk2535d602003-07-17 23:16:40 +00001988 if(bit) immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdat |= PB_SCL; \
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +00001989 else immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdat &= ~PB_SCL
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001990
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001991 I2C_DELAY
1992
1993 This delay is invoked four times per clock cycle so this
1994 controls the rate of data transfer. The data rate thus
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001995 is 1 / (I2C_DELAY * 4). Often defined to be something
wdenk945af8d2003-07-16 21:53:01 +00001996 like:
1997
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001998 #define I2C_DELAY udelay(2)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001999
Mike Frysinger793b5722010-07-21 13:38:02 -04002000 CONFIG_SOFT_I2C_GPIO_SCL / CONFIG_SOFT_I2C_GPIO_SDA
2001
2002 If your arch supports the generic GPIO framework (asm/gpio.h),
2003 then you may alternatively define the two GPIOs that are to be
2004 used as SCL / SDA. Any of the previous I2C_xxx macros will
2005 have GPIO-based defaults assigned to them as appropriate.
2006
2007 You should define these to the GPIO value as given directly to
2008 the generic GPIO functions.
2009
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002010 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_INIT_BOARD
wdenk47cd00f2003-03-06 13:39:27 +00002011
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00002012 When a board is reset during an i2c bus transfer
2013 chips might think that the current transfer is still
2014 in progress. On some boards it is possible to access
2015 the i2c SCLK line directly, either by using the
2016 processor pin as a GPIO or by having a second pin
2017 connected to the bus. If this option is defined a
2018 custom i2c_init_board() routine in boards/xxx/board.c
2019 is run early in the boot sequence.
wdenk47cd00f2003-03-06 13:39:27 +00002020
Richard Retanubun26a33502010-04-12 15:08:17 -04002021 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_BOARD_LATE_INIT
2022
2023 An alternative to CONFIG_SYS_I2C_INIT_BOARD. If this option is
2024 defined a custom i2c_board_late_init() routine in
2025 boards/xxx/board.c is run AFTER the operations in i2c_init()
2026 is completed. This callpoint can be used to unreset i2c bus
2027 using CPU i2c controller register accesses for CPUs whose i2c
2028 controller provide such a method. It is called at the end of
2029 i2c_init() to allow i2c_init operations to setup the i2c bus
2030 controller on the CPU (e.g. setting bus speed & slave address).
2031
wdenk17ea1172004-06-06 21:51:03 +00002032 CONFIG_I2CFAST (PPC405GP|PPC405EP only)
2033
2034 This option enables configuration of bi_iic_fast[] flags
2035 in u-boot bd_info structure based on u-boot environment
2036 variable "i2cfast". (see also i2cfast)
2037
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04002038 CONFIG_I2C_MULTI_BUS
2039
2040 This option allows the use of multiple I2C buses, each of which
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00002041 must have a controller. At any point in time, only one bus is
2042 active. To switch to a different bus, use the 'i2c dev' command.
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04002043 Note that bus numbering is zero-based.
2044
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002045 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_NOPROBES
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04002046
2047 This option specifies a list of I2C devices that will be skipped
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00002048 when the 'i2c probe' command is issued. If CONFIG_I2C_MULTI_BUS
Peter Tyser0f89c542009-04-18 22:34:03 -05002049 is set, specify a list of bus-device pairs. Otherwise, specify
2050 a 1D array of device addresses
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04002051
2052 e.g.
2053 #undef CONFIG_I2C_MULTI_BUS
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00002054 #define CONFIG_SYS_I2C_NOPROBES {0x50,0x68}
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04002055
2056 will skip addresses 0x50 and 0x68 on a board with one I2C bus
2057
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00002058 #define CONFIG_I2C_MULTI_BUS
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002059 #define CONFIG_SYS_I2C_MULTI_NOPROBES {{0,0x50},{0,0x68},{1,0x54}}
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04002060
2061 will skip addresses 0x50 and 0x68 on bus 0 and address 0x54 on bus 1
2062
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002063 CONFIG_SYS_SPD_BUS_NUM
Timur Tabibe5e6182006-11-03 19:15:00 -06002064
2065 If defined, then this indicates the I2C bus number for DDR SPD.
2066 If not defined, then U-Boot assumes that SPD is on I2C bus 0.
2067
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002068 CONFIG_SYS_RTC_BUS_NUM
Stefan Roese0dc018e2007-02-20 10:51:26 +01002069
2070 If defined, then this indicates the I2C bus number for the RTC.
2071 If not defined, then U-Boot assumes that RTC is on I2C bus 0.
2072
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002073 CONFIG_SYS_DTT_BUS_NUM
Stefan Roese0dc018e2007-02-20 10:51:26 +01002074
2075 If defined, then this indicates the I2C bus number for the DTT.
2076 If not defined, then U-Boot assumes that DTT is on I2C bus 0.
2077
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002078 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_DTT_ADDR:
Victor Gallardo9ebbb542008-09-09 15:13:29 -07002079
2080 If defined, specifies the I2C address of the DTT device.
2081 If not defined, then U-Boot uses predefined value for
2082 specified DTT device.
2083
Timur Tabibe5e6182006-11-03 19:15:00 -06002084 CONFIG_FSL_I2C
2085
2086 Define this option if you want to use Freescale's I2C driver in
Marcel Ziswiler7817cb22007-12-30 03:30:46 +01002087 drivers/i2c/fsl_i2c.c.
Timur Tabibe5e6182006-11-03 19:15:00 -06002088
Heiko Schocher67b23a32008-10-15 09:39:47 +02002089 CONFIG_I2C_MUX
2090
2091 Define this option if you have I2C devices reached over 1 .. n
2092 I2C Muxes like the pca9544a. This option addes a new I2C
2093 Command "i2c bus [muxtype:muxaddr:muxchannel]" which adds a
2094 new I2C Bus to the existing I2C Busses. If you select the
2095 new Bus with "i2c dev", u-bbot sends first the commandos for
2096 the muxes to activate this new "bus".
2097
2098 CONFIG_I2C_MULTI_BUS must be also defined, to use this
2099 feature!
2100
2101 Example:
2102 Adding a new I2C Bus reached over 2 pca9544a muxes
2103 The First mux with address 70 and channel 6
2104 The Second mux with address 71 and channel 4
2105
2106 => i2c bus pca9544a:70:6:pca9544a:71:4
2107
2108 Use the "i2c bus" command without parameter, to get a list
2109 of I2C Busses with muxes:
2110
2111 => i2c bus
2112 Busses reached over muxes:
2113 Bus ID: 2
2114 reached over Mux(es):
2115 pca9544a@70 ch: 4
2116 Bus ID: 3
2117 reached over Mux(es):
2118 pca9544a@70 ch: 6
2119 pca9544a@71 ch: 4
2120 =>
2121
2122 If you now switch to the new I2C Bus 3 with "i2c dev 3"
Michael Jonesf9a78b82011-07-14 22:09:28 +00002123 u-boot first sends the command to the mux@70 to enable
2124 channel 6, and then the command to the mux@71 to enable
Heiko Schocher67b23a32008-10-15 09:39:47 +02002125 the channel 4.
2126
2127 After that, you can use the "normal" i2c commands as
Michael Jonesf9a78b82011-07-14 22:09:28 +00002128 usual to communicate with your I2C devices behind
Heiko Schocher67b23a32008-10-15 09:39:47 +02002129 the 2 muxes.
2130
2131 This option is actually implemented for the bitbanging
2132 algorithm in common/soft_i2c.c and for the Hardware I2C
2133 Bus on the MPC8260. But it should be not so difficult
2134 to add this option to other architectures.
2135
Andrew Dyer2ac69852008-12-29 17:36:01 -06002136 CONFIG_SOFT_I2C_READ_REPEATED_START
2137
2138 defining this will force the i2c_read() function in
2139 the soft_i2c driver to perform an I2C repeated start
2140 between writing the address pointer and reading the
2141 data. If this define is omitted the default behaviour
2142 of doing a stop-start sequence will be used. Most I2C
2143 devices can use either method, but some require one or
2144 the other.
Timur Tabibe5e6182006-11-03 19:15:00 -06002145
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002146- SPI Support: CONFIG_SPI
2147
2148 Enables SPI driver (so far only tested with
2149 SPI EEPROM, also an instance works with Crystal A/D and
2150 D/As on the SACSng board)
2151
Yoshihiro Shimoda66395622011-01-31 16:50:43 +09002152 CONFIG_SH_SPI
2153
2154 Enables the driver for SPI controller on SuperH. Currently
2155 only SH7757 is supported.
2156
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002157 CONFIG_SPI_X
2158
2159 Enables extended (16-bit) SPI EEPROM addressing.
2160 (symmetrical to CONFIG_I2C_X)
2161
2162 CONFIG_SOFT_SPI
2163
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002164 Enables a software (bit-bang) SPI driver rather than
2165 using hardware support. This is a general purpose
2166 driver that only requires three general I/O port pins
2167 (two outputs, one input) to function. If this is
2168 defined, the board configuration must define several
2169 SPI configuration items (port pins to use, etc). For
2170 an example, see include/configs/sacsng.h.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002171
Ben Warren04a9e112008-01-16 22:37:35 -05002172 CONFIG_HARD_SPI
2173
2174 Enables a hardware SPI driver for general-purpose reads
2175 and writes. As with CONFIG_SOFT_SPI, the board configuration
2176 must define a list of chip-select function pointers.
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00002177 Currently supported on some MPC8xxx processors. For an
Ben Warren04a9e112008-01-16 22:37:35 -05002178 example, see include/configs/mpc8349emds.h.
2179
Guennadi Liakhovetski38254f42008-04-15 14:14:25 +02002180 CONFIG_MXC_SPI
2181
2182 Enables the driver for the SPI controllers on i.MX and MXC
Fabio Estevam2e3cd1c2011-10-28 08:57:46 +00002183 SoCs. Currently i.MX31/35/51 are supported.
Guennadi Liakhovetski38254f42008-04-15 14:14:25 +02002184
Matthias Fuchs01335022007-12-27 17:12:34 +01002185- FPGA Support: CONFIG_FPGA
2186
2187 Enables FPGA subsystem.
2188
2189 CONFIG_FPGA_<vendor>
2190
2191 Enables support for specific chip vendors.
2192 (ALTERA, XILINX)
2193
2194 CONFIG_FPGA_<family>
2195
2196 Enables support for FPGA family.
2197 (SPARTAN2, SPARTAN3, VIRTEX2, CYCLONE2, ACEX1K, ACEX)
2198
2199 CONFIG_FPGA_COUNT
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002200
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002201 Specify the number of FPGA devices to support.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002202
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002203 CONFIG_SYS_FPGA_PROG_FEEDBACK
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002204
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00002205 Enable printing of hash marks during FPGA configuration.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002206
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002207 CONFIG_SYS_FPGA_CHECK_BUSY
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002208
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002209 Enable checks on FPGA configuration interface busy
2210 status by the configuration function. This option
2211 will require a board or device specific function to
2212 be written.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002213
2214 CONFIG_FPGA_DELAY
2215
2216 If defined, a function that provides delays in the FPGA
2217 configuration driver.
2218
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002219 CONFIG_SYS_FPGA_CHECK_CTRLC
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002220 Allow Control-C to interrupt FPGA configuration
2221
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002222 CONFIG_SYS_FPGA_CHECK_ERROR
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002223
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002224 Check for configuration errors during FPGA bitfile
2225 loading. For example, abort during Virtex II
2226 configuration if the INIT_B line goes low (which
2227 indicated a CRC error).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002228
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002229 CONFIG_SYS_FPGA_WAIT_INIT
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002230
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002231 Maximum time to wait for the INIT_B line to deassert
2232 after PROB_B has been deasserted during a Virtex II
2233 FPGA configuration sequence. The default time is 500
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002234 ms.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002235
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002236 CONFIG_SYS_FPGA_WAIT_BUSY
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002237
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002238 Maximum time to wait for BUSY to deassert during
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002239 Virtex II FPGA configuration. The default is 5 ms.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002240
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002241 CONFIG_SYS_FPGA_WAIT_CONFIG
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002242
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002243 Time to wait after FPGA configuration. The default is
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002244 200 ms.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002245
2246- Configuration Management:
2247 CONFIG_IDENT_STRING
2248
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002249 If defined, this string will be added to the U-Boot
2250 version information (U_BOOT_VERSION)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002251
2252- Vendor Parameter Protection:
2253
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002254 U-Boot considers the values of the environment
2255 variables "serial#" (Board Serial Number) and
wdenk7152b1d2003-09-05 23:19:14 +00002256 "ethaddr" (Ethernet Address) to be parameters that
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002257 are set once by the board vendor / manufacturer, and
2258 protects these variables from casual modification by
2259 the user. Once set, these variables are read-only,
2260 and write or delete attempts are rejected. You can
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002261 change this behaviour:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002262
2263 If CONFIG_ENV_OVERWRITE is #defined in your config
2264 file, the write protection for vendor parameters is
wdenk47cd00f2003-03-06 13:39:27 +00002265 completely disabled. Anybody can change or delete
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002266 these parameters.
2267
2268 Alternatively, if you #define _both_ CONFIG_ETHADDR
2269 _and_ CONFIG_OVERWRITE_ETHADDR_ONCE, a default
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002270 Ethernet address is installed in the environment,
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002271 which can be changed exactly ONCE by the user. [The
2272 serial# is unaffected by this, i. e. it remains
2273 read-only.]
2274
Joe Hershberger25980902012-12-11 22:16:31 -06002275 The same can be accomplished in a more flexible way
2276 for any variable by configuring the type of access
2277 to allow for those variables in the ".flags" variable
2278 or define CONFIG_ENV_FLAGS_LIST_STATIC.
2279
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002280- Protected RAM:
2281 CONFIG_PRAM
2282
2283 Define this variable to enable the reservation of
2284 "protected RAM", i. e. RAM which is not overwritten
2285 by U-Boot. Define CONFIG_PRAM to hold the number of
2286 kB you want to reserve for pRAM. You can overwrite
2287 this default value by defining an environment
2288 variable "pram" to the number of kB you want to
2289 reserve. Note that the board info structure will
2290 still show the full amount of RAM. If pRAM is
2291 reserved, a new environment variable "mem" will
2292 automatically be defined to hold the amount of
2293 remaining RAM in a form that can be passed as boot
2294 argument to Linux, for instance like that:
2295
Wolfgang Denkfe126d82005-11-20 21:40:11 +01002296 setenv bootargs ... mem=\${mem}
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002297 saveenv
2298
2299 This way you can tell Linux not to use this memory,
2300 either, which results in a memory region that will
2301 not be affected by reboots.
2302
2303 *WARNING* If your board configuration uses automatic
2304 detection of the RAM size, you must make sure that
2305 this memory test is non-destructive. So far, the
2306 following board configurations are known to be
2307 "pRAM-clean":
2308
Wolfgang Denk1b0757e2012-10-24 02:36:15 +00002309 IVMS8, IVML24, SPD8xx, TQM8xxL,
2310 HERMES, IP860, RPXlite, LWMON,
Wolfgang Denk544d97e2010-10-05 22:54:53 +02002311 FLAGADM, TQM8260
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002312
Gabe Black40fef042012-12-02 04:55:18 +00002313- Access to physical memory region (> 4GB)
2314 Some basic support is provided for operations on memory not
2315 normally accessible to U-Boot - e.g. some architectures
2316 support access to more than 4GB of memory on 32-bit
2317 machines using physical address extension or similar.
2318 Define CONFIG_PHYSMEM to access this basic support, which
2319 currently only supports clearing the memory.
2320
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002321- Error Recovery:
2322 CONFIG_PANIC_HANG
2323
2324 Define this variable to stop the system in case of a
2325 fatal error, so that you have to reset it manually.
2326 This is probably NOT a good idea for an embedded
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002327 system where you want the system to reboot
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002328 automatically as fast as possible, but it may be
2329 useful during development since you can try to debug
2330 the conditions that lead to the situation.
2331
2332 CONFIG_NET_RETRY_COUNT
2333
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002334 This variable defines the number of retries for
2335 network operations like ARP, RARP, TFTP, or BOOTP
2336 before giving up the operation. If not defined, a
2337 default value of 5 is used.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002338
Guennadi Liakhovetski40cb90e2008-04-03 17:04:19 +02002339 CONFIG_ARP_TIMEOUT
2340
2341 Timeout waiting for an ARP reply in milliseconds.
2342
Tetsuyuki Kobayashi48a3e992012-07-03 22:25:21 +00002343 CONFIG_NFS_TIMEOUT
2344
2345 Timeout in milliseconds used in NFS protocol.
2346 If you encounter "ERROR: Cannot umount" in nfs command,
2347 try longer timeout such as
2348 #define CONFIG_NFS_TIMEOUT 10000UL
2349
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002350- Command Interpreter:
Wolfgang Denk8078f1a2006-10-28 02:28:02 +02002351 CONFIG_AUTO_COMPLETE
wdenk04a85b32004-04-15 18:22:41 +00002352
2353 Enable auto completion of commands using TAB.
2354
Wolfgang Denka9398e02006-11-27 15:32:42 +01002355 Note that this feature has NOT been implemented yet
2356 for the "hush" shell.
Wolfgang Denk8078f1a2006-10-28 02:28:02 +02002357
2358
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002359 CONFIG_SYS_HUSH_PARSER
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002360
2361 Define this variable to enable the "hush" shell (from
2362 Busybox) as command line interpreter, thus enabling
2363 powerful command line syntax like
2364 if...then...else...fi conditionals or `&&' and '||'
2365 constructs ("shell scripts").
2366
2367 If undefined, you get the old, much simpler behaviour
2368 with a somewhat smaller memory footprint.
2369
2370
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002371 CONFIG_SYS_PROMPT_HUSH_PS2
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002372
2373 This defines the secondary prompt string, which is
2374 printed when the command interpreter needs more input
2375 to complete a command. Usually "> ".
2376
2377 Note:
2378
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00002379 In the current implementation, the local variables
2380 space and global environment variables space are
2381 separated. Local variables are those you define by
2382 simply typing `name=value'. To access a local
2383 variable later on, you have write `$name' or
2384 `${name}'; to execute the contents of a variable
2385 directly type `$name' at the command prompt.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002386
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002387 Global environment variables are those you use
2388 setenv/printenv to work with. To run a command stored
2389 in such a variable, you need to use the run command,
2390 and you must not use the '$' sign to access them.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002391
2392 To store commands and special characters in a
2393 variable, please use double quotation marks
2394 surrounding the whole text of the variable, instead
2395 of the backslashes before semicolons and special
2396 symbols.
2397
Wolfgang Denkaa0c71a2006-07-21 11:35:21 +02002398- Commandline Editing and History:
2399 CONFIG_CMDLINE_EDITING
2400
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002401 Enable editing and History functions for interactive
Wolfgang Denkb9365a22006-07-21 11:56:05 +02002402 commandline input operations
Wolfgang Denkaa0c71a2006-07-21 11:35:21 +02002403
wdenka8c7c702003-12-06 19:49:23 +00002404- Default Environment:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002405 CONFIG_EXTRA_ENV_SETTINGS
2406
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002407 Define this to contain any number of null terminated
2408 strings (variable = value pairs) that will be part of
wdenk7152b1d2003-09-05 23:19:14 +00002409 the default environment compiled into the boot image.
wdenk2262cfe2002-11-18 00:14:45 +00002410
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002411 For example, place something like this in your
2412 board's config file:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002413
2414 #define CONFIG_EXTRA_ENV_SETTINGS \
2415 "myvar1=value1\0" \
2416 "myvar2=value2\0"
2417
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002418 Warning: This method is based on knowledge about the
2419 internal format how the environment is stored by the
2420 U-Boot code. This is NOT an official, exported
2421 interface! Although it is unlikely that this format
wdenk7152b1d2003-09-05 23:19:14 +00002422 will change soon, there is no guarantee either.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002423 You better know what you are doing here.
2424
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002425 Note: overly (ab)use of the default environment is
2426 discouraged. Make sure to check other ways to preset
Wolfgang Denk74de7ae2009-04-01 23:34:12 +02002427 the environment like the "source" command or the
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002428 boot command first.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002429
Stephen Warren5e724ca2012-05-22 09:21:54 +00002430 CONFIG_ENV_VARS_UBOOT_CONFIG
2431
2432 Define this in order to add variables describing the
2433 U-Boot build configuration to the default environment.
2434 These will be named arch, cpu, board, vendor, and soc.
2435
2436 Enabling this option will cause the following to be defined:
2437
2438 - CONFIG_SYS_ARCH
2439 - CONFIG_SYS_CPU
2440 - CONFIG_SYS_BOARD
2441 - CONFIG_SYS_VENDOR
2442 - CONFIG_SYS_SOC
2443
Tom Rini7e27f892012-10-24 07:28:16 +00002444 CONFIG_ENV_VARS_UBOOT_RUNTIME_CONFIG
2445
2446 Define this in order to add variables describing certain
2447 run-time determined information about the hardware to the
2448 environment. These will be named board_name, board_rev.
2449
Simon Glass06fd8532012-11-30 13:01:17 +00002450 CONFIG_DELAY_ENVIRONMENT
2451
2452 Normally the environment is loaded when the board is
2453 intialised so that it is available to U-Boot. This inhibits
2454 that so that the environment is not available until
2455 explicitly loaded later by U-Boot code. With CONFIG_OF_CONTROL
2456 this is instead controlled by the value of
2457 /config/load-environment.
2458
wdenka8c7c702003-12-06 19:49:23 +00002459- DataFlash Support:
wdenk2abbe072003-06-16 23:50:08 +00002460 CONFIG_HAS_DATAFLASH
2461
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00002462 Defining this option enables DataFlash features and
2463 allows to read/write in Dataflash via the standard
2464 commands cp, md...
wdenk2abbe072003-06-16 23:50:08 +00002465
Eric Nelsonf61ec452012-01-31 10:52:08 -07002466- Serial Flash support
2467 CONFIG_CMD_SF
2468
2469 Defining this option enables SPI flash commands
2470 'sf probe/read/write/erase/update'.
2471
2472 Usage requires an initial 'probe' to define the serial
2473 flash parameters, followed by read/write/erase/update
2474 commands.
2475
2476 The following defaults may be provided by the platform
2477 to handle the common case when only a single serial
2478 flash is present on the system.
2479
2480 CONFIG_SF_DEFAULT_BUS Bus identifier
2481 CONFIG_SF_DEFAULT_CS Chip-select
2482 CONFIG_SF_DEFAULT_MODE (see include/spi.h)
2483 CONFIG_SF_DEFAULT_SPEED in Hz
2484
Simon Glass24007272012-10-08 13:16:02 +00002485 CONFIG_CMD_SF_TEST
2486
2487 Define this option to include a destructive SPI flash
2488 test ('sf test').
2489
wdenk3f85ce22004-02-23 16:11:30 +00002490- SystemACE Support:
2491 CONFIG_SYSTEMACE
2492
2493 Adding this option adds support for Xilinx SystemACE
2494 chips attached via some sort of local bus. The address
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002495 of the chip must also be defined in the
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002496 CONFIG_SYS_SYSTEMACE_BASE macro. For example:
wdenk3f85ce22004-02-23 16:11:30 +00002497
2498 #define CONFIG_SYSTEMACE
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002499 #define CONFIG_SYS_SYSTEMACE_BASE 0xf0000000
wdenk3f85ce22004-02-23 16:11:30 +00002500
2501 When SystemACE support is added, the "ace" device type
2502 becomes available to the fat commands, i.e. fatls.
2503
Wolfgang Denkecb0ccd2005-09-24 22:37:32 +02002504- TFTP Fixed UDP Port:
2505 CONFIG_TFTP_PORT
2506
Wolfgang Denk28cb9372005-09-24 23:25:46 +02002507 If this is defined, the environment variable tftpsrcp
Wolfgang Denkecb0ccd2005-09-24 22:37:32 +02002508 is used to supply the TFTP UDP source port value.
Wolfgang Denk28cb9372005-09-24 23:25:46 +02002509 If tftpsrcp isn't defined, the normal pseudo-random port
Wolfgang Denkecb0ccd2005-09-24 22:37:32 +02002510 number generator is used.
2511
Wolfgang Denk28cb9372005-09-24 23:25:46 +02002512 Also, the environment variable tftpdstp is used to supply
2513 the TFTP UDP destination port value. If tftpdstp isn't
2514 defined, the normal port 69 is used.
2515
2516 The purpose for tftpsrcp is to allow a TFTP server to
Wolfgang Denkecb0ccd2005-09-24 22:37:32 +02002517 blindly start the TFTP transfer using the pre-configured
2518 target IP address and UDP port. This has the effect of
2519 "punching through" the (Windows XP) firewall, allowing
2520 the remainder of the TFTP transfer to proceed normally.
2521 A better solution is to properly configure the firewall,
2522 but sometimes that is not allowed.
2523
Simon Glassbf36c5d2012-12-05 14:46:38 +00002524- Hashing support:
2525 CONFIG_CMD_HASH
2526
2527 This enables a generic 'hash' command which can produce
2528 hashes / digests from a few algorithms (e.g. SHA1, SHA256).
2529
2530 CONFIG_HASH_VERIFY
2531
2532 Enable the hash verify command (hash -v). This adds to code
2533 size a little.
2534
2535 CONFIG_SHA1 - support SHA1 hashing
2536 CONFIG_SHA256 - support SHA256 hashing
2537
2538 Note: There is also a sha1sum command, which should perhaps
2539 be deprecated in favour of 'hash sha1'.
2540
wdenka8c7c702003-12-06 19:49:23 +00002541- Show boot progress:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002542 CONFIG_SHOW_BOOT_PROGRESS
2543
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002544 Defining this option allows to add some board-
2545 specific code (calling a user-provided function
2546 "show_boot_progress(int)") that enables you to show
2547 the system's boot progress on some display (for
2548 example, some LED's) on your board. At the moment,
2549 the following checkpoints are implemented:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002550
Simon Glass3a608ca2012-02-13 13:51:19 +00002551- Detailed boot stage timing
2552 CONFIG_BOOTSTAGE
2553 Define this option to get detailed timing of each stage
2554 of the boot process.
2555
2556 CONFIG_BOOTSTAGE_USER_COUNT
2557 This is the number of available user bootstage records.
2558 Each time you call bootstage_mark(BOOTSTAGE_ID_ALLOC, ...)
2559 a new ID will be allocated from this stash. If you exceed
2560 the limit, recording will stop.
2561
2562 CONFIG_BOOTSTAGE_REPORT
2563 Define this to print a report before boot, similar to this:
2564
2565 Timer summary in microseconds:
2566 Mark Elapsed Stage
2567 0 0 reset
2568 3,575,678 3,575,678 board_init_f start
2569 3,575,695 17 arch_cpu_init A9
2570 3,575,777 82 arch_cpu_init done
2571 3,659,598 83,821 board_init_r start
2572 3,910,375 250,777 main_loop
2573 29,916,167 26,005,792 bootm_start
2574 30,361,327 445,160 start_kernel
2575
Simon Glass2eba38c2012-09-28 08:56:39 +00002576 CONFIG_CMD_BOOTSTAGE
2577 Add a 'bootstage' command which supports printing a report
2578 and un/stashing of bootstage data.
2579
Simon Glass94fd1312012-09-28 08:56:37 +00002580 CONFIG_BOOTSTAGE_FDT
2581 Stash the bootstage information in the FDT. A root 'bootstage'
2582 node is created with each bootstage id as a child. Each child
2583 has a 'name' property and either 'mark' containing the
2584 mark time in microsecond, or 'accum' containing the
2585 accumulated time for that bootstage id in microseconds.
2586 For example:
2587
2588 bootstage {
2589 154 {
2590 name = "board_init_f";
2591 mark = <3575678>;
2592 };
2593 170 {
2594 name = "lcd";
2595 accum = <33482>;
2596 };
2597 };
2598
2599 Code in the Linux kernel can find this in /proc/devicetree.
2600
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002601Legacy uImage format:
2602
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002603 Arg Where When
2604 1 common/cmd_bootm.c before attempting to boot an image
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +00002605 -1 common/cmd_bootm.c Image header has bad magic number
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002606 2 common/cmd_bootm.c Image header has correct magic number
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +00002607 -2 common/cmd_bootm.c Image header has bad checksum
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002608 3 common/cmd_bootm.c Image header has correct checksum
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +00002609 -3 common/cmd_bootm.c Image data has bad checksum
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002610 4 common/cmd_bootm.c Image data has correct checksum
2611 -4 common/cmd_bootm.c Image is for unsupported architecture
2612 5 common/cmd_bootm.c Architecture check OK
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002613 -5 common/cmd_bootm.c Wrong Image Type (not kernel, multi)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002614 6 common/cmd_bootm.c Image Type check OK
2615 -6 common/cmd_bootm.c gunzip uncompression error
2616 -7 common/cmd_bootm.c Unimplemented compression type
2617 7 common/cmd_bootm.c Uncompression OK
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002618 8 common/cmd_bootm.c No uncompress/copy overwrite error
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002619 -9 common/cmd_bootm.c Unsupported OS (not Linux, BSD, VxWorks, QNX)
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002620
2621 9 common/image.c Start initial ramdisk verification
2622 -10 common/image.c Ramdisk header has bad magic number
2623 -11 common/image.c Ramdisk header has bad checksum
2624 10 common/image.c Ramdisk header is OK
2625 -12 common/image.c Ramdisk data has bad checksum
2626 11 common/image.c Ramdisk data has correct checksum
2627 12 common/image.c Ramdisk verification complete, start loading
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002628 -13 common/image.c Wrong Image Type (not PPC Linux ramdisk)
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002629 13 common/image.c Start multifile image verification
2630 14 common/image.c No initial ramdisk, no multifile, continue.
2631
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00002632 15 arch/<arch>/lib/bootm.c All preparation done, transferring control to OS
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002633
Stefan Roesea47a12b2010-04-15 16:07:28 +02002634 -30 arch/powerpc/lib/board.c Fatal error, hang the system
wdenk11dadd52004-02-27 00:07:27 +00002635 -31 post/post.c POST test failed, detected by post_output_backlog()
2636 -32 post/post.c POST test failed, detected by post_run_single()
wdenk63e73c92004-02-23 22:22:28 +00002637
Heiko Schocher566a4942007-06-22 19:11:54 +02002638 34 common/cmd_doc.c before loading a Image from a DOC device
2639 -35 common/cmd_doc.c Bad usage of "doc" command
2640 35 common/cmd_doc.c correct usage of "doc" command
2641 -36 common/cmd_doc.c No boot device
2642 36 common/cmd_doc.c correct boot device
2643 -37 common/cmd_doc.c Unknown Chip ID on boot device
2644 37 common/cmd_doc.c correct chip ID found, device available
2645 -38 common/cmd_doc.c Read Error on boot device
2646 38 common/cmd_doc.c reading Image header from DOC device OK
2647 -39 common/cmd_doc.c Image header has bad magic number
2648 39 common/cmd_doc.c Image header has correct magic number
2649 -40 common/cmd_doc.c Error reading Image from DOC device
2650 40 common/cmd_doc.c Image header has correct magic number
2651 41 common/cmd_ide.c before loading a Image from a IDE device
2652 -42 common/cmd_ide.c Bad usage of "ide" command
2653 42 common/cmd_ide.c correct usage of "ide" command
2654 -43 common/cmd_ide.c No boot device
2655 43 common/cmd_ide.c boot device found
2656 -44 common/cmd_ide.c Device not available
2657 44 common/cmd_ide.c Device available
2658 -45 common/cmd_ide.c wrong partition selected
2659 45 common/cmd_ide.c partition selected
2660 -46 common/cmd_ide.c Unknown partition table
2661 46 common/cmd_ide.c valid partition table found
2662 -47 common/cmd_ide.c Invalid partition type
2663 47 common/cmd_ide.c correct partition type
2664 -48 common/cmd_ide.c Error reading Image Header on boot device
2665 48 common/cmd_ide.c reading Image Header from IDE device OK
2666 -49 common/cmd_ide.c Image header has bad magic number
2667 49 common/cmd_ide.c Image header has correct magic number
2668 -50 common/cmd_ide.c Image header has bad checksum
2669 50 common/cmd_ide.c Image header has correct checksum
2670 -51 common/cmd_ide.c Error reading Image from IDE device
2671 51 common/cmd_ide.c reading Image from IDE device OK
2672 52 common/cmd_nand.c before loading a Image from a NAND device
2673 -53 common/cmd_nand.c Bad usage of "nand" command
2674 53 common/cmd_nand.c correct usage of "nand" command
2675 -54 common/cmd_nand.c No boot device
2676 54 common/cmd_nand.c boot device found
2677 -55 common/cmd_nand.c Unknown Chip ID on boot device
2678 55 common/cmd_nand.c correct chip ID found, device available
2679 -56 common/cmd_nand.c Error reading Image Header on boot device
2680 56 common/cmd_nand.c reading Image Header from NAND device OK
2681 -57 common/cmd_nand.c Image header has bad magic number
2682 57 common/cmd_nand.c Image header has correct magic number
2683 -58 common/cmd_nand.c Error reading Image from NAND device
2684 58 common/cmd_nand.c reading Image from NAND device OK
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002685
Heiko Schocher566a4942007-06-22 19:11:54 +02002686 -60 common/env_common.c Environment has a bad CRC, using default
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002687
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002688 64 net/eth.c starting with Ethernet configuration.
Heiko Schocher566a4942007-06-22 19:11:54 +02002689 -64 net/eth.c no Ethernet found.
2690 65 net/eth.c Ethernet found.
wdenk206c60c2003-09-18 10:02:25 +00002691
Heiko Schocher566a4942007-06-22 19:11:54 +02002692 -80 common/cmd_net.c usage wrong
2693 80 common/cmd_net.c before calling NetLoop()
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002694 -81 common/cmd_net.c some error in NetLoop() occurred
Heiko Schocher566a4942007-06-22 19:11:54 +02002695 81 common/cmd_net.c NetLoop() back without error
2696 -82 common/cmd_net.c size == 0 (File with size 0 loaded)
2697 82 common/cmd_net.c trying automatic boot
Wolfgang Denk74de7ae2009-04-01 23:34:12 +02002698 83 common/cmd_net.c running "source" command
2699 -83 common/cmd_net.c some error in automatic boot or "source" command
Heiko Schocher566a4942007-06-22 19:11:54 +02002700 84 common/cmd_net.c end without errors
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002701
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002702FIT uImage format:
2703
2704 Arg Where When
2705 100 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel FIT Image has correct format
2706 -100 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel FIT Image has incorrect format
2707 101 common/cmd_bootm.c No Kernel subimage unit name, using configuration
2708 -101 common/cmd_bootm.c Can't get configuration for kernel subimage
2709 102 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel unit name specified
2710 -103 common/cmd_bootm.c Can't get kernel subimage node offset
Marian Balakowiczf773bea2008-03-12 10:35:46 +01002711 103 common/cmd_bootm.c Found configuration node
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002712 104 common/cmd_bootm.c Got kernel subimage node offset
2713 -104 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel subimage hash verification failed
2714 105 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel subimage hash verification OK
2715 -105 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel subimage is for unsupported architecture
2716 106 common/cmd_bootm.c Architecture check OK
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002717 -106 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel subimage has wrong type
2718 107 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel subimage type OK
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002719 -107 common/cmd_bootm.c Can't get kernel subimage data/size
2720 108 common/cmd_bootm.c Got kernel subimage data/size
2721 -108 common/cmd_bootm.c Wrong image type (not legacy, FIT)
2722 -109 common/cmd_bootm.c Can't get kernel subimage type
2723 -110 common/cmd_bootm.c Can't get kernel subimage comp
2724 -111 common/cmd_bootm.c Can't get kernel subimage os
2725 -112 common/cmd_bootm.c Can't get kernel subimage load address
2726 -113 common/cmd_bootm.c Image uncompress/copy overwrite error
2727
2728 120 common/image.c Start initial ramdisk verification
2729 -120 common/image.c Ramdisk FIT image has incorrect format
2730 121 common/image.c Ramdisk FIT image has correct format
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002731 122 common/image.c No ramdisk subimage unit name, using configuration
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002732 -122 common/image.c Can't get configuration for ramdisk subimage
2733 123 common/image.c Ramdisk unit name specified
2734 -124 common/image.c Can't get ramdisk subimage node offset
2735 125 common/image.c Got ramdisk subimage node offset
2736 -125 common/image.c Ramdisk subimage hash verification failed
2737 126 common/image.c Ramdisk subimage hash verification OK
2738 -126 common/image.c Ramdisk subimage for unsupported architecture
2739 127 common/image.c Architecture check OK
2740 -127 common/image.c Can't get ramdisk subimage data/size
2741 128 common/image.c Got ramdisk subimage data/size
2742 129 common/image.c Can't get ramdisk load address
2743 -129 common/image.c Got ramdisk load address
2744
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002745 -130 common/cmd_doc.c Incorrect FIT image format
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002746 131 common/cmd_doc.c FIT image format OK
2747
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002748 -140 common/cmd_ide.c Incorrect FIT image format
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002749 141 common/cmd_ide.c FIT image format OK
2750
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002751 -150 common/cmd_nand.c Incorrect FIT image format
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002752 151 common/cmd_nand.c FIT image format OK
2753
Gabe Blackd95f6ec2012-10-25 16:31:10 +00002754- FIT image support:
2755 CONFIG_FIT
2756 Enable support for the FIT uImage format.
2757
2758 CONFIG_FIT_BEST_MATCH
2759 When no configuration is explicitly selected, default to the
2760 one whose fdt's compatibility field best matches that of
2761 U-Boot itself. A match is considered "best" if it matches the
2762 most specific compatibility entry of U-Boot's fdt's root node.
2763 The order of entries in the configuration's fdt is ignored.
2764
Wolfgang Denk4cf26092011-10-07 09:58:21 +02002765- Standalone program support:
2766 CONFIG_STANDALONE_LOAD_ADDR
2767
Wolfgang Denk6feff892011-10-09 21:06:34 +02002768 This option defines a board specific value for the
2769 address where standalone program gets loaded, thus
2770 overwriting the architecture dependent default
Wolfgang Denk4cf26092011-10-07 09:58:21 +02002771 settings.
2772
2773- Frame Buffer Address:
2774 CONFIG_FB_ADDR
2775
2776 Define CONFIG_FB_ADDR if you want to use specific
Wolfgang Denk44a53b52013-01-03 00:43:59 +00002777 address for frame buffer. This is typically the case
2778 when using a graphics controller has separate video
2779 memory. U-Boot will then place the frame buffer at
2780 the given address instead of dynamically reserving it
2781 in system RAM by calling lcd_setmem(), which grabs
2782 the memory for the frame buffer depending on the
2783 configured panel size.
Wolfgang Denk4cf26092011-10-07 09:58:21 +02002784
2785 Please see board_init_f function.
2786
Detlev Zundelcccfc2a2009-12-01 17:16:19 +01002787- Automatic software updates via TFTP server
2788 CONFIG_UPDATE_TFTP
2789 CONFIG_UPDATE_TFTP_CNT_MAX
2790 CONFIG_UPDATE_TFTP_MSEC_MAX
2791
2792 These options enable and control the auto-update feature;
2793 for a more detailed description refer to doc/README.update.
2794
2795- MTD Support (mtdparts command, UBI support)
2796 CONFIG_MTD_DEVICE
2797
2798 Adds the MTD device infrastructure from the Linux kernel.
2799 Needed for mtdparts command support.
2800
2801 CONFIG_MTD_PARTITIONS
2802
2803 Adds the MTD partitioning infrastructure from the Linux
2804 kernel. Needed for UBI support.
2805
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00002806- SPL framework
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02002807 CONFIG_SPL
2808 Enable building of SPL globally.
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00002809
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00002810 CONFIG_SPL_LDSCRIPT
2811 LDSCRIPT for linking the SPL binary.
2812
2813 CONFIG_SPL_MAX_SIZE
2814 Maximum binary size (text, data and rodata) of the SPL binary.
2815
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02002816 CONFIG_SPL_TEXT_BASE
2817 TEXT_BASE for linking the SPL binary.
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00002818
Scott Wood94a45bb2012-09-20 19:05:12 -05002819 CONFIG_SPL_RELOC_TEXT_BASE
2820 Address to relocate to. If unspecified, this is equal to
2821 CONFIG_SPL_TEXT_BASE (i.e. no relocation is done).
2822
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00002823 CONFIG_SPL_BSS_START_ADDR
2824 Link address for the BSS within the SPL binary.
2825
2826 CONFIG_SPL_BSS_MAX_SIZE
2827 Maximum binary size of the BSS section of the SPL binary.
2828
2829 CONFIG_SPL_STACK
2830 Adress of the start of the stack SPL will use
2831
Scott Wood94a45bb2012-09-20 19:05:12 -05002832 CONFIG_SPL_RELOC_STACK
2833 Adress of the start of the stack SPL will use after
2834 relocation. If unspecified, this is equal to
2835 CONFIG_SPL_STACK.
2836
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00002837 CONFIG_SYS_SPL_MALLOC_START
2838 Starting address of the malloc pool used in SPL.
2839
2840 CONFIG_SYS_SPL_MALLOC_SIZE
2841 The size of the malloc pool used in SPL.
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00002842
Tom Rini47f7bca2012-08-13 12:03:19 -07002843 CONFIG_SPL_FRAMEWORK
2844 Enable the SPL framework under common/. This framework
2845 supports MMC, NAND and YMODEM loading of U-Boot and NAND
2846 NAND loading of the Linux Kernel.
2847
Tom Rini861a86f2012-08-13 11:37:56 -07002848 CONFIG_SPL_DISPLAY_PRINT
2849 For ARM, enable an optional function to print more information
2850 about the running system.
2851
Scott Wood4b919722012-09-20 16:35:21 -05002852 CONFIG_SPL_INIT_MINIMAL
2853 Arch init code should be built for a very small image
2854
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02002855 CONFIG_SPL_LIBCOMMON_SUPPORT
2856 Support for common/libcommon.o in SPL binary
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00002857
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02002858 CONFIG_SPL_LIBDISK_SUPPORT
2859 Support for disk/libdisk.o in SPL binary
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00002860
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02002861 CONFIG_SPL_I2C_SUPPORT
2862 Support for drivers/i2c/libi2c.o in SPL binary
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00002863
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02002864 CONFIG_SPL_GPIO_SUPPORT
2865 Support for drivers/gpio/libgpio.o in SPL binary
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00002866
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02002867 CONFIG_SPL_MMC_SUPPORT
2868 Support for drivers/mmc/libmmc.o in SPL binary
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00002869
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00002870 CONFIG_SYS_MMCSD_RAW_MODE_U_BOOT_SECTOR,
2871 CONFIG_SYS_U_BOOT_MAX_SIZE_SECTORS,
2872 CONFIG_SYS_MMC_SD_FAT_BOOT_PARTITION
2873 Address, size and partition on the MMC to load U-Boot from
2874 when the MMC is being used in raw mode.
2875
2876 CONFIG_SPL_FAT_SUPPORT
2877 Support for fs/fat/libfat.o in SPL binary
2878
2879 CONFIG_SPL_FAT_LOAD_PAYLOAD_NAME
2880 Filename to read to load U-Boot when reading from FAT
2881
Scott Wood06f60ae2012-12-06 13:33:17 +00002882 CONFIG_SPL_MPC83XX_WAIT_FOR_NAND
2883 Set this for NAND SPL on PPC mpc83xx targets, so that
2884 start.S waits for the rest of the SPL to load before
2885 continuing (the hardware starts execution after just
2886 loading the first page rather than the full 4K).
2887
Scott Wood6f2f01b2012-09-20 19:09:07 -05002888 CONFIG_SPL_NAND_BASE
2889 Include nand_base.c in the SPL. Requires
2890 CONFIG_SPL_NAND_DRIVERS.
2891
2892 CONFIG_SPL_NAND_DRIVERS
2893 SPL uses normal NAND drivers, not minimal drivers.
2894
2895 CONFIG_SPL_NAND_ECC
2896 Include standard software ECC in the SPL
2897
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00002898 CONFIG_SPL_NAND_SIMPLE
Scott Wood7d4b7952012-09-21 18:35:27 -05002899 Support for NAND boot using simple NAND drivers that
2900 expose the cmd_ctrl() interface.
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00002901
2902 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_5_ADDR_CYCLE, CONFIG_SYS_NAND_PAGE_COUNT,
2903 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_PAGE_SIZE, CONFIG_SYS_NAND_OOBSIZE,
2904 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_BLOCK_SIZE, CONFIG_SYS_NAND_BAD_BLOCK_POS,
2905 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_ECCPOS, CONFIG_SYS_NAND_ECCSIZE,
2906 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_ECCBYTES
2907 Defines the size and behavior of the NAND that SPL uses
Scott Wood7d4b7952012-09-21 18:35:27 -05002908 to read U-Boot
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00002909
2910 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_U_BOOT_OFFS
Scott Wood7d4b7952012-09-21 18:35:27 -05002911 Location in NAND to read U-Boot from
2912
2913 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_U_BOOT_DST
2914 Location in memory to load U-Boot to
2915
2916 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_U_BOOT_SIZE
2917 Size of image to load
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00002918
2919 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_U_BOOT_START
Scott Wood7d4b7952012-09-21 18:35:27 -05002920 Entry point in loaded image to jump to
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00002921
2922 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_HW_ECC_OOBFIRST
2923 Define this if you need to first read the OOB and then the
2924 data. This is used for example on davinci plattforms.
2925
2926 CONFIG_SPL_OMAP3_ID_NAND
2927 Support for an OMAP3-specific set of functions to return the
2928 ID and MFR of the first attached NAND chip, if present.
2929
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02002930 CONFIG_SPL_SERIAL_SUPPORT
2931 Support for drivers/serial/libserial.o in SPL binary
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00002932
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02002933 CONFIG_SPL_SPI_FLASH_SUPPORT
2934 Support for drivers/mtd/spi/libspi_flash.o in SPL binary
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00002935
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02002936 CONFIG_SPL_SPI_SUPPORT
2937 Support for drivers/spi/libspi.o in SPL binary
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00002938
Pavel Machekc57b9532012-08-30 22:42:11 +02002939 CONFIG_SPL_RAM_DEVICE
2940 Support for running image already present in ram, in SPL binary
2941
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02002942 CONFIG_SPL_LIBGENERIC_SUPPORT
2943 Support for lib/libgeneric.o in SPL binary
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002944
Scott Wood74752ba2012-12-06 13:33:16 +00002945 CONFIG_SPL_PAD_TO
2946 Linker address to which the SPL should be padded before
2947 appending the SPL payload.
2948
Scott Woodca2fca22012-09-21 16:27:32 -05002949 CONFIG_SPL_TARGET
2950 Final target image containing SPL and payload. Some SPLs
2951 use an arch-specific makefile fragment instead, for
2952 example if more than one image needs to be produced.
2953
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002954Modem Support:
2955--------------
2956
Wolfgang Denk566e5cf2011-05-01 20:44:23 +02002957[so far only for SMDK2400 boards]
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002958
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002959- Modem support enable:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002960 CONFIG_MODEM_SUPPORT
2961
2962- RTS/CTS Flow control enable:
2963 CONFIG_HWFLOW
2964
2965- Modem debug support:
2966 CONFIG_MODEM_SUPPORT_DEBUG
2967
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002968 Enables debugging stuff (char screen[1024], dbg())
2969 for modem support. Useful only with BDI2000.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002970
wdenka8c7c702003-12-06 19:49:23 +00002971- Interrupt support (PPC):
2972
wdenkd4ca31c2004-01-02 14:00:00 +00002973 There are common interrupt_init() and timer_interrupt()
2974 for all PPC archs. interrupt_init() calls interrupt_init_cpu()
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002975 for CPU specific initialization. interrupt_init_cpu()
wdenkd4ca31c2004-01-02 14:00:00 +00002976 should set decrementer_count to appropriate value. If
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002977 CPU resets decrementer automatically after interrupt
wdenkd4ca31c2004-01-02 14:00:00 +00002978 (ppc4xx) it should set decrementer_count to zero.
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002979 timer_interrupt() calls timer_interrupt_cpu() for CPU
wdenkd4ca31c2004-01-02 14:00:00 +00002980 specific handling. If board has watchdog / status_led
2981 / other_activity_monitor it works automatically from
2982 general timer_interrupt().
wdenka8c7c702003-12-06 19:49:23 +00002983
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002984- General:
2985
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002986 In the target system modem support is enabled when a
2987 specific key (key combination) is pressed during
2988 power-on. Otherwise U-Boot will boot normally
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002989 (autoboot). The key_pressed() function is called from
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002990 board_init(). Currently key_pressed() is a dummy
2991 function, returning 1 and thus enabling modem
2992 initialization.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002993
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002994 If there are no modem init strings in the
2995 environment, U-Boot proceed to autoboot; the
2996 previous output (banner, info printfs) will be
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002997 suppressed, though.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002998
2999 See also: doc/README.Modem
3000
Helmut Raiger9660e442011-10-20 04:19:47 +00003001Board initialization settings:
3002------------------------------
3003
3004During Initialization u-boot calls a number of board specific functions
3005to allow the preparation of board specific prerequisites, e.g. pin setup
3006before drivers are initialized. To enable these callbacks the
3007following configuration macros have to be defined. Currently this is
3008architecture specific, so please check arch/your_architecture/lib/board.c
3009typically in board_init_f() and board_init_r().
3010
3011- CONFIG_BOARD_EARLY_INIT_F: Call board_early_init_f()
3012- CONFIG_BOARD_EARLY_INIT_R: Call board_early_init_r()
3013- CONFIG_BOARD_LATE_INIT: Call board_late_init()
3014- CONFIG_BOARD_POSTCLK_INIT: Call board_postclk_init()
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003015
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003016Configuration Settings:
3017-----------------------
3018
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003019- CONFIG_SYS_LONGHELP: Defined when you want long help messages included;
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003020 undefine this when you're short of memory.
3021
Peter Tyser2fb26042009-01-27 18:03:12 -06003022- CONFIG_SYS_HELP_CMD_WIDTH: Defined when you want to override the default
3023 width of the commands listed in the 'help' command output.
3024
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003025- CONFIG_SYS_PROMPT: This is what U-Boot prints on the console to
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003026 prompt for user input.
3027
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003028- CONFIG_SYS_CBSIZE: Buffer size for input from the Console
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003029
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003030- CONFIG_SYS_PBSIZE: Buffer size for Console output
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003031
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003032- CONFIG_SYS_MAXARGS: max. Number of arguments accepted for monitor commands
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003033
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003034- CONFIG_SYS_BARGSIZE: Buffer size for Boot Arguments which are passed to
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003035 the application (usually a Linux kernel) when it is
3036 booted
3037
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003038- CONFIG_SYS_BAUDRATE_TABLE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003039 List of legal baudrate settings for this board.
3040
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003041- CONFIG_SYS_CONSOLE_INFO_QUIET
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00003042 Suppress display of console information at boot.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003043
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003044- CONFIG_SYS_CONSOLE_IS_IN_ENV
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00003045 If the board specific function
3046 extern int overwrite_console (void);
3047 returns 1, the stdin, stderr and stdout are switched to the
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003048 serial port, else the settings in the environment are used.
3049
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003050- CONFIG_SYS_CONSOLE_OVERWRITE_ROUTINE
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00003051 Enable the call to overwrite_console().
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003052
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003053- CONFIG_SYS_CONSOLE_ENV_OVERWRITE
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003054 Enable overwrite of previous console environment settings.
3055
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003056- CONFIG_SYS_MEMTEST_START, CONFIG_SYS_MEMTEST_END:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003057 Begin and End addresses of the area used by the
3058 simple memory test.
3059
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003060- CONFIG_SYS_ALT_MEMTEST:
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00003061 Enable an alternate, more extensive memory test.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003062
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003063- CONFIG_SYS_MEMTEST_SCRATCH:
wdenk5f535fe2003-09-18 09:21:33 +00003064 Scratch address used by the alternate memory test
3065 You only need to set this if address zero isn't writeable
3066
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003067- CONFIG_SYS_MEM_TOP_HIDE (PPC only):
3068 If CONFIG_SYS_MEM_TOP_HIDE is defined in the board config header,
Stefan Roese14f73ca2008-03-26 10:14:11 +01003069 this specified memory area will get subtracted from the top
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003070 (end) of RAM and won't get "touched" at all by U-Boot. By
Stefan Roese14f73ca2008-03-26 10:14:11 +01003071 fixing up gd->ram_size the Linux kernel should gets passed
3072 the now "corrected" memory size and won't touch it either.
3073 This should work for arch/ppc and arch/powerpc. Only Linux
Stefan Roese5e12e752008-03-28 11:02:53 +01003074 board ports in arch/powerpc with bootwrapper support that
Stefan Roese14f73ca2008-03-26 10:14:11 +01003075 recalculate the memory size from the SDRAM controller setup
Stefan Roese5e12e752008-03-28 11:02:53 +01003076 will have to get fixed in Linux additionally.
Stefan Roese14f73ca2008-03-26 10:14:11 +01003077
3078 This option can be used as a workaround for the 440EPx/GRx
3079 CHIP 11 errata where the last 256 bytes in SDRAM shouldn't
3080 be touched.
3081
3082 WARNING: Please make sure that this value is a multiple of
3083 the Linux page size (normally 4k). If this is not the case,
3084 then the end address of the Linux memory will be located at a
3085 non page size aligned address and this could cause major
3086 problems.
3087
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003088- CONFIG_SYS_LOADS_BAUD_CHANGE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003089 Enable temporary baudrate change while serial download
3090
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003091- CONFIG_SYS_SDRAM_BASE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003092 Physical start address of SDRAM. _Must_ be 0 here.
3093
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003094- CONFIG_SYS_MBIO_BASE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003095 Physical start address of Motherboard I/O (if using a
3096 Cogent motherboard)
3097
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003098- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_BASE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003099 Physical start address of Flash memory.
3100
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003101- CONFIG_SYS_MONITOR_BASE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003102 Physical start address of boot monitor code (set by
3103 make config files to be same as the text base address
Wolfgang Denk14d0a022010-10-07 21:51:12 +02003104 (CONFIG_SYS_TEXT_BASE) used when linking) - same as
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003105 CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_BASE when booting from flash.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003106
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003107- CONFIG_SYS_MONITOR_LEN:
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00003108 Size of memory reserved for monitor code, used to
3109 determine _at_compile_time_ (!) if the environment is
3110 embedded within the U-Boot image, or in a separate
3111 flash sector.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003112
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003113- CONFIG_SYS_MALLOC_LEN:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003114 Size of DRAM reserved for malloc() use.
3115
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003116- CONFIG_SYS_BOOTM_LEN:
Stefan Roese15940c92006-03-13 11:16:36 +01003117 Normally compressed uImages are limited to an
3118 uncompressed size of 8 MBytes. If this is not enough,
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003119 you can define CONFIG_SYS_BOOTM_LEN in your board config file
Stefan Roese15940c92006-03-13 11:16:36 +01003120 to adjust this setting to your needs.
3121
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003122- CONFIG_SYS_BOOTMAPSZ:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003123 Maximum size of memory mapped by the startup code of
3124 the Linux kernel; all data that must be processed by
Bartlomiej Sieka7d721e32008-04-14 15:44:16 +02003125 the Linux kernel (bd_info, boot arguments, FDT blob if
3126 used) must be put below this limit, unless "bootm_low"
3127 enviroment variable is defined and non-zero. In such case
3128 all data for the Linux kernel must be between "bootm_low"
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00003129 and "bootm_low" + CONFIG_SYS_BOOTMAPSZ. The environment
Grant Likelyc3624e62011-03-28 09:58:43 +00003130 variable "bootm_mapsize" will override the value of
3131 CONFIG_SYS_BOOTMAPSZ. If CONFIG_SYS_BOOTMAPSZ is undefined,
3132 then the value in "bootm_size" will be used instead.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003133
John Rigbyfca43cc2010-10-13 13:57:35 -06003134- CONFIG_SYS_BOOT_RAMDISK_HIGH:
3135 Enable initrd_high functionality. If defined then the
3136 initrd_high feature is enabled and the bootm ramdisk subcommand
3137 is enabled.
3138
3139- CONFIG_SYS_BOOT_GET_CMDLINE:
3140 Enables allocating and saving kernel cmdline in space between
3141 "bootm_low" and "bootm_low" + BOOTMAPSZ.
3142
3143- CONFIG_SYS_BOOT_GET_KBD:
3144 Enables allocating and saving a kernel copy of the bd_info in
3145 space between "bootm_low" and "bootm_low" + BOOTMAPSZ.
3146
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003147- CONFIG_SYS_MAX_FLASH_BANKS:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003148 Max number of Flash memory banks
3149
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003150- CONFIG_SYS_MAX_FLASH_SECT:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003151 Max number of sectors on a Flash chip
3152
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003153- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_ERASE_TOUT:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003154 Timeout for Flash erase operations (in ms)
3155
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003156- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_WRITE_TOUT:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003157 Timeout for Flash write operations (in ms)
3158
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003159- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_LOCK_TOUT
wdenk8564acf2003-07-14 22:13:32 +00003160 Timeout for Flash set sector lock bit operation (in ms)
3161
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003162- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_UNLOCK_TOUT
wdenk8564acf2003-07-14 22:13:32 +00003163 Timeout for Flash clear lock bits operation (in ms)
3164
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003165- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_PROTECTION
wdenk8564acf2003-07-14 22:13:32 +00003166 If defined, hardware flash sectors protection is used
3167 instead of U-Boot software protection.
3168
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003169- CONFIG_SYS_DIRECT_FLASH_TFTP:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003170
3171 Enable TFTP transfers directly to flash memory;
3172 without this option such a download has to be
3173 performed in two steps: (1) download to RAM, and (2)
3174 copy from RAM to flash.
3175
3176 The two-step approach is usually more reliable, since
3177 you can check if the download worked before you erase
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003178 the flash, but in some situations (when system RAM is
3179 too limited to allow for a temporary copy of the
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003180 downloaded image) this option may be very useful.
3181
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003182- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_CFI:
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00003183 Define if the flash driver uses extra elements in the
wdenk5653fc32004-02-08 22:55:38 +00003184 common flash structure for storing flash geometry.
3185
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD00b18832008-08-13 01:40:42 +02003186- CONFIG_FLASH_CFI_DRIVER
wdenk5653fc32004-02-08 22:55:38 +00003187 This option also enables the building of the cfi_flash driver
3188 in the drivers directory
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003189
Piotr Ziecik91809ed2008-11-17 15:57:58 +01003190- CONFIG_FLASH_CFI_MTD
3191 This option enables the building of the cfi_mtd driver
3192 in the drivers directory. The driver exports CFI flash
3193 to the MTD layer.
3194
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003195- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_USE_BUFFER_WRITE
Guennadi Liakhovetski96ef8312008-04-03 13:36:02 +02003196 Use buffered writes to flash.
3197
3198- CONFIG_FLASH_SPANSION_S29WS_N
3199 s29ws-n MirrorBit flash has non-standard addresses for buffered
3200 write commands.
3201
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003202- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_QUIET_TEST
Stefan Roese5568e612005-11-22 13:20:42 +01003203 If this option is defined, the common CFI flash doesn't
3204 print it's warning upon not recognized FLASH banks. This
3205 is useful, if some of the configured banks are only
3206 optionally available.
3207
Jerry Van Baren9a042e92008-03-08 13:48:01 -05003208- CONFIG_FLASH_SHOW_PROGRESS
3209 If defined (must be an integer), print out countdown
3210 digits and dots. Recommended value: 45 (9..1) for 80
3211 column displays, 15 (3..1) for 40 column displays.
3212
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003213- CONFIG_SYS_RX_ETH_BUFFER:
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003214 Defines the number of Ethernet receive buffers. On some
3215 Ethernet controllers it is recommended to set this value
stroese53cf9432003-06-05 15:39:44 +00003216 to 8 or even higher (EEPRO100 or 405 EMAC), since all
3217 buffers can be full shortly after enabling the interface
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003218 on high Ethernet traffic.
stroese53cf9432003-06-05 15:39:44 +00003219 Defaults to 4 if not defined.
3220
Wolfgang Denkea882ba2010-06-20 23:33:59 +02003221- CONFIG_ENV_MAX_ENTRIES
3222
Wolfgang Denk071bc922010-10-27 22:48:30 +02003223 Maximum number of entries in the hash table that is used
3224 internally to store the environment settings. The default
3225 setting is supposed to be generous and should work in most
3226 cases. This setting can be used to tune behaviour; see
3227 lib/hashtable.c for details.
Wolfgang Denkea882ba2010-06-20 23:33:59 +02003228
Joe Hershberger25980902012-12-11 22:16:31 -06003229- CONFIG_ENV_FLAGS_LIST_DEFAULT
3230- CONFIG_ENV_FLAGS_LIST_STATIC
3231 Enable validation of the values given to enviroment variables when
3232 calling env set. Variables can be restricted to only decimal,
3233 hexadecimal, or boolean. If CONFIG_CMD_NET is also defined,
3234 the variables can also be restricted to IP address or MAC address.
3235
3236 The format of the list is:
3237 type_attribute = [s|d|x|b|i|m]
Joe Hershberger267541f2012-12-11 22:16:34 -06003238 access_atribute = [a|r|o|c]
3239 attributes = type_attribute[access_atribute]
Joe Hershberger25980902012-12-11 22:16:31 -06003240 entry = variable_name[:attributes]
3241 list = entry[,list]
3242
3243 The type attributes are:
3244 s - String (default)
3245 d - Decimal
3246 x - Hexadecimal
3247 b - Boolean ([1yYtT|0nNfF])
3248 i - IP address
3249 m - MAC address
3250
Joe Hershberger267541f2012-12-11 22:16:34 -06003251 The access attributes are:
3252 a - Any (default)
3253 r - Read-only
3254 o - Write-once
3255 c - Change-default
3256
Joe Hershberger25980902012-12-11 22:16:31 -06003257 - CONFIG_ENV_FLAGS_LIST_DEFAULT
3258 Define this to a list (string) to define the ".flags"
3259 envirnoment variable in the default or embedded environment.
3260
3261 - CONFIG_ENV_FLAGS_LIST_STATIC
3262 Define this to a list (string) to define validation that
3263 should be done if an entry is not found in the ".flags"
3264 environment variable. To override a setting in the static
3265 list, simply add an entry for the same variable name to the
3266 ".flags" variable.
3267
Joe Hershberger267541f2012-12-11 22:16:34 -06003268- CONFIG_ENV_ACCESS_IGNORE_FORCE
3269 If defined, don't allow the -f switch to env set override variable
3270 access flags.
3271
Simon Glass5c1a7ea2013-03-08 13:45:27 +00003272- CONFIG_SYS_GENERIC_BOARD
3273 This selects the architecture-generic board system instead of the
3274 architecture-specific board files. It is intended to move boards
3275 to this new framework over time. Defining this will disable the
3276 arch/foo/lib/board.c file and use common/board_f.c and
3277 common/board_r.c instead. To use this option your architecture
3278 must support it (i.e. must define __HAVE_ARCH_GENERIC_BOARD in
3279 its config.mk file). If you find problems enabling this option on
3280 your board please report the problem and send patches!
3281
Simon Glass632efa72013-03-11 07:06:48 +00003282- CONFIG_SYS_SYM_OFFSETS
3283 This is set by architectures that use offsets for link symbols
3284 instead of absolute values. So bss_start is obtained using an
3285 offset _bss_start_ofs from CONFIG_SYS_TEXT_BASE, rather than
3286 directly. You should not need to touch this setting.
3287
3288
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003289The following definitions that deal with the placement and management
3290of environment data (variable area); in general, we support the
3291following configurations:
3292
Mike Frysingerc3eb3fe2011-07-08 10:44:25 +00003293- CONFIG_BUILD_ENVCRC:
3294
3295 Builds up envcrc with the target environment so that external utils
3296 may easily extract it and embed it in final U-Boot images.
3297
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD5a1aceb2008-09-10 22:48:04 +02003298- CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_FLASH:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003299
3300 Define this if the environment is in flash memory.
3301
3302 a) The environment occupies one whole flash sector, which is
3303 "embedded" in the text segment with the U-Boot code. This
3304 happens usually with "bottom boot sector" or "top boot
3305 sector" type flash chips, which have several smaller
3306 sectors at the start or the end. For instance, such a
3307 layout can have sector sizes of 8, 2x4, 16, Nx32 kB. In
3308 such a case you would place the environment in one of the
3309 4 kB sectors - with U-Boot code before and after it. With
3310 "top boot sector" type flash chips, you would put the
3311 environment in one of the last sectors, leaving a gap
3312 between U-Boot and the environment.
3313
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02003314 - CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003315
3316 Offset of environment data (variable area) to the
3317 beginning of flash memory; for instance, with bottom boot
3318 type flash chips the second sector can be used: the offset
3319 for this sector is given here.
3320
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003321 CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET is used relative to CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_BASE.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003322
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02003323 - CONFIG_ENV_ADDR:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003324
3325 This is just another way to specify the start address of
3326 the flash sector containing the environment (instead of
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02003327 CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003328
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02003329 - CONFIG_ENV_SECT_SIZE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003330
3331 Size of the sector containing the environment.
3332
3333
3334 b) Sometimes flash chips have few, equal sized, BIG sectors.
3335 In such a case you don't want to spend a whole sector for
3336 the environment.
3337
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02003338 - CONFIG_ENV_SIZE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003339
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD5a1aceb2008-09-10 22:48:04 +02003340 If you use this in combination with CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_FLASH
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02003341 and CONFIG_ENV_SECT_SIZE, you can specify to use only a part
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003342 of this flash sector for the environment. This saves
3343 memory for the RAM copy of the environment.
3344
3345 It may also save flash memory if you decide to use this
3346 when your environment is "embedded" within U-Boot code,
3347 since then the remainder of the flash sector could be used
3348 for U-Boot code. It should be pointed out that this is
3349 STRONGLY DISCOURAGED from a robustness point of view:
3350 updating the environment in flash makes it always
3351 necessary to erase the WHOLE sector. If something goes
3352 wrong before the contents has been restored from a copy in
3353 RAM, your target system will be dead.
3354
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02003355 - CONFIG_ENV_ADDR_REDUND
3356 CONFIG_ENV_SIZE_REDUND
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003357
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00003358 These settings describe a second storage area used to hold
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003359 a redundant copy of the environment data, so that there is
wdenk3e386912003-04-05 00:53:31 +00003360 a valid backup copy in case there is a power failure during
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00003361 a "saveenv" operation.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003362
3363BE CAREFUL! Any changes to the flash layout, and some changes to the
3364source code will make it necessary to adapt <board>/u-boot.lds*
3365accordingly!
3366
3367
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD9314cee2008-09-10 22:47:59 +02003368- CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_NVRAM:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003369
3370 Define this if you have some non-volatile memory device
3371 (NVRAM, battery buffered SRAM) which you want to use for the
3372 environment.
3373
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02003374 - CONFIG_ENV_ADDR:
3375 - CONFIG_ENV_SIZE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003376
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003377 These two #defines are used to determine the memory area you
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003378 want to use for environment. It is assumed that this memory
3379 can just be read and written to, without any special
3380 provision.
3381
3382BE CAREFUL! The first access to the environment happens quite early
3383in U-Boot initalization (when we try to get the setting of for the
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003384console baudrate). You *MUST* have mapped your NVRAM area then, or
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003385U-Boot will hang.
3386
3387Please note that even with NVRAM we still use a copy of the
3388environment in RAM: we could work on NVRAM directly, but we want to
3389keep settings there always unmodified except somebody uses "saveenv"
3390to save the current settings.
3391
3392
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARDbb1f8b42008-09-05 09:19:30 +02003393- CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_EEPROM:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003394
3395 Use this if you have an EEPROM or similar serial access
3396 device and a driver for it.
3397
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02003398 - CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET:
3399 - CONFIG_ENV_SIZE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003400
3401 These two #defines specify the offset and size of the
3402 environment area within the total memory of your EEPROM.
3403
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003404 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_EEPROM_ADDR:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003405 If defined, specified the chip address of the EEPROM device.
3406 The default address is zero.
3407
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003408 - CONFIG_SYS_EEPROM_PAGE_WRITE_BITS:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003409 If defined, the number of bits used to address bytes in a
3410 single page in the EEPROM device. A 64 byte page, for example
3411 would require six bits.
3412
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003413 - CONFIG_SYS_EEPROM_PAGE_WRITE_DELAY_MS:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003414 If defined, the number of milliseconds to delay between
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +00003415 page writes. The default is zero milliseconds.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003416
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003417 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_EEPROM_ADDR_LEN:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003418 The length in bytes of the EEPROM memory array address. Note
3419 that this is NOT the chip address length!
3420
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003421 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_EEPROM_ADDR_OVERFLOW:
wdenk5cf91d62004-04-23 20:32:05 +00003422 EEPROM chips that implement "address overflow" are ones
3423 like Catalyst 24WC04/08/16 which has 9/10/11 bits of
3424 address and the extra bits end up in the "chip address" bit
3425 slots. This makes a 24WC08 (1Kbyte) chip look like four 256
3426 byte chips.
3427
3428 Note that we consider the length of the address field to
3429 still be one byte because the extra address bits are hidden
3430 in the chip address.
3431
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003432 - CONFIG_SYS_EEPROM_SIZE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003433 The size in bytes of the EEPROM device.
3434
Heiko Schocher548738b2010-01-07 08:55:40 +01003435 - CONFIG_ENV_EEPROM_IS_ON_I2C
3436 define this, if you have I2C and SPI activated, and your
3437 EEPROM, which holds the environment, is on the I2C bus.
3438
3439 - CONFIG_I2C_ENV_EEPROM_BUS
3440 if you have an Environment on an EEPROM reached over
3441 I2C muxes, you can define here, how to reach this
3442 EEPROM. For example:
3443
Wolfgang Denka9046b92010-06-13 17:48:15 +02003444 #define CONFIG_I2C_ENV_EEPROM_BUS "pca9547:70:d\0"
Heiko Schocher548738b2010-01-07 08:55:40 +01003445
3446 EEPROM which holds the environment, is reached over
3447 a pca9547 i2c mux with address 0x70, channel 3.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003448
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD057c8492008-09-10 22:47:58 +02003449- CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_DATAFLASH:
wdenk5779d8d2003-12-06 23:55:10 +00003450
wdenkd4ca31c2004-01-02 14:00:00 +00003451 Define this if you have a DataFlash memory device which you
wdenk5779d8d2003-12-06 23:55:10 +00003452 want to use for the environment.
3453
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02003454 - CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET:
3455 - CONFIG_ENV_ADDR:
3456 - CONFIG_ENV_SIZE:
wdenk5779d8d2003-12-06 23:55:10 +00003457
3458 These three #defines specify the offset and size of the
3459 environment area within the total memory of your DataFlash placed
3460 at the specified address.
3461
Liu Gang0a85a9e2012-03-08 00:33:20 +00003462- CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_REMOTE:
3463
3464 Define this if you have a remote memory space which you
3465 want to use for the local device's environment.
3466
3467 - CONFIG_ENV_ADDR:
3468 - CONFIG_ENV_SIZE:
3469
3470 These two #defines specify the address and size of the
3471 environment area within the remote memory space. The
3472 local device can get the environment from remote memory
Liu Gangfc54c7f2012-08-09 05:10:01 +00003473 space by SRIO or PCIE links.
Liu Gang0a85a9e2012-03-08 00:33:20 +00003474
3475BE CAREFUL! For some special cases, the local device can not use
3476"saveenv" command. For example, the local device will get the
Liu Gangfc54c7f2012-08-09 05:10:01 +00003477environment stored in a remote NOR flash by SRIO or PCIE link,
3478but it can not erase, write this NOR flash by SRIO or PCIE interface.
Liu Gang0a85a9e2012-03-08 00:33:20 +00003479
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD51bfee12008-09-10 22:47:58 +02003480- CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_NAND:
wdenk13a56952004-06-09 14:58:14 +00003481
3482 Define this if you have a NAND device which you want to use
3483 for the environment.
3484
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02003485 - CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET:
3486 - CONFIG_ENV_SIZE:
wdenk13a56952004-06-09 14:58:14 +00003487
3488 These two #defines specify the offset and size of the environment
Scott Woodfdd813d2010-09-17 14:38:37 -05003489 area within the first NAND device. CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET must be
3490 aligned to an erase block boundary.
wdenk5779d8d2003-12-06 23:55:10 +00003491
Scott Woodfdd813d2010-09-17 14:38:37 -05003492 - CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET_REDUND (optional):
Markus Klotzbuechere443c942006-03-20 18:02:44 +01003493
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02003494 This setting describes a second storage area of CONFIG_ENV_SIZE
Scott Woodfdd813d2010-09-17 14:38:37 -05003495 size used to hold a redundant copy of the environment data, so
3496 that there is a valid backup copy in case there is a power failure
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00003497 during a "saveenv" operation. CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET_RENDUND must be
Scott Woodfdd813d2010-09-17 14:38:37 -05003498 aligned to an erase block boundary.
Markus Klotzbuechere443c942006-03-20 18:02:44 +01003499
Scott Woodfdd813d2010-09-17 14:38:37 -05003500 - CONFIG_ENV_RANGE (optional):
3501
3502 Specifies the length of the region in which the environment
3503 can be written. This should be a multiple of the NAND device's
3504 block size. Specifying a range with more erase blocks than
3505 are needed to hold CONFIG_ENV_SIZE allows bad blocks within
3506 the range to be avoided.
3507
3508 - CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET_OOB (optional):
3509
3510 Enables support for dynamically retrieving the offset of the
3511 environment from block zero's out-of-band data. The
3512 "nand env.oob" command can be used to record this offset.
3513 Currently, CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET_REDUND is not supported when
3514 using CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET_OOB.
Markus Klotzbuechere443c942006-03-20 18:02:44 +01003515
Guennadi Liakhovetskib74ab732009-05-18 16:07:22 +02003516- CONFIG_NAND_ENV_DST
3517
3518 Defines address in RAM to which the nand_spl code should copy the
3519 environment. If redundant environment is used, it will be copied to
3520 CONFIG_NAND_ENV_DST + CONFIG_ENV_SIZE.
3521
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003522- CONFIG_SYS_SPI_INIT_OFFSET
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003523
3524 Defines offset to the initial SPI buffer area in DPRAM. The
3525 area is used at an early stage (ROM part) if the environment
3526 is configured to reside in the SPI EEPROM: We need a 520 byte
3527 scratch DPRAM area. It is used between the two initialization
3528 calls (spi_init_f() and spi_init_r()). A value of 0xB00 seems
3529 to be a good choice since it makes it far enough from the
3530 start of the data area as well as from the stack pointer.
3531
Bruce Adlere881cb52007-11-02 13:15:42 -07003532Please note that the environment is read-only until the monitor
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003533has been relocated to RAM and a RAM copy of the environment has been
Wolfgang Denkcdb74972010-07-24 21:55:43 +02003534created; also, when using EEPROM you will have to use getenv_f()
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003535until then to read environment variables.
3536
wdenk85ec0bc2003-03-31 16:34:49 +00003537The environment is protected by a CRC32 checksum. Before the monitor
3538is relocated into RAM, as a result of a bad CRC you will be working
3539with the compiled-in default environment - *silently*!!! [This is
3540necessary, because the first environment variable we need is the
3541"baudrate" setting for the console - if we have a bad CRC, we don't
3542have any device yet where we could complain.]
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003543
3544Note: once the monitor has been relocated, then it will complain if
3545the default environment is used; a new CRC is computed as soon as you
wdenk85ec0bc2003-03-31 16:34:49 +00003546use the "saveenv" command to store a valid environment.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003547
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003548- CONFIG_SYS_FAULT_ECHO_LINK_DOWN:
wdenk42d1f032003-10-15 23:53:47 +00003549 Echo the inverted Ethernet link state to the fault LED.
wdenkfc3e2162003-10-08 22:33:00 +00003550
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003551 Note: If this option is active, then CONFIG_SYS_FAULT_MII_ADDR
wdenkfc3e2162003-10-08 22:33:00 +00003552 also needs to be defined.
3553
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003554- CONFIG_SYS_FAULT_MII_ADDR:
wdenk42d1f032003-10-15 23:53:47 +00003555 MII address of the PHY to check for the Ethernet link state.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003556
Ron Madridf5675aa2009-02-18 14:30:44 -08003557- CONFIG_NS16550_MIN_FUNCTIONS:
3558 Define this if you desire to only have use of the NS16550_init
3559 and NS16550_putc functions for the serial driver located at
3560 drivers/serial/ns16550.c. This option is useful for saving
3561 space for already greatly restricted images, including but not
3562 limited to NAND_SPL configurations.
3563
Simon Glassb2b92f52012-11-30 13:01:18 +00003564- CONFIG_DISPLAY_BOARDINFO
3565 Display information about the board that U-Boot is running on
3566 when U-Boot starts up. The board function checkboard() is called
3567 to do this.
3568
Simon Glasse2e3e2b2012-11-30 13:01:19 +00003569- CONFIG_DISPLAY_BOARDINFO_LATE
3570 Similar to the previous option, but display this information
3571 later, once stdio is running and output goes to the LCD, if
3572 present.
3573
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003574Low Level (hardware related) configuration options:
wdenkdc7c9a12003-03-26 06:55:25 +00003575---------------------------------------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003576
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003577- CONFIG_SYS_CACHELINE_SIZE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003578 Cache Line Size of the CPU.
3579
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003580- CONFIG_SYS_DEFAULT_IMMR:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003581 Default address of the IMMR after system reset.
wdenk2535d602003-07-17 23:16:40 +00003582
wdenk42d1f032003-10-15 23:53:47 +00003583 Needed on some 8260 systems (MPC8260ADS, PQ2FADS-ZU,
3584 and RPXsuper) to be able to adjust the position of
3585 the IMMR register after a reset.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003586
Timur Tabie46fedf2011-08-04 18:03:41 -05003587- CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_DEFAULT:
3588 Default (power-on reset) physical address of CCSR on Freescale
3589 PowerPC SOCs.
3590
3591- CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR:
3592 Virtual address of CCSR. On a 32-bit build, this is typically
3593 the same value as CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_DEFAULT.
3594
3595 CONFIG_SYS_DEFAULT_IMMR must also be set to this value,
3596 for cross-platform code that uses that macro instead.
3597
3598- CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS:
3599 Physical address of CCSR. CCSR can be relocated to a new
3600 physical address, if desired. In this case, this macro should
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00003601 be set to that address. Otherwise, it should be set to the
Timur Tabie46fedf2011-08-04 18:03:41 -05003602 same value as CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_DEFAULT. For example, CCSR
3603 is typically relocated on 36-bit builds. It is recommended
3604 that this macro be defined via the _HIGH and _LOW macros:
3605
3606 #define CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS ((CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS_HIGH
3607 * 1ull) << 32 | CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS_LOW)
3608
3609- CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS_HIGH:
Wolfgang Denk4cf26092011-10-07 09:58:21 +02003610 Bits 33-36 of CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS. This value is typically
3611 either 0 (32-bit build) or 0xF (36-bit build). This macro is
Timur Tabie46fedf2011-08-04 18:03:41 -05003612 used in assembly code, so it must not contain typecasts or
3613 integer size suffixes (e.g. "ULL").
3614
3615- CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS_LOW:
3616 Lower 32-bits of CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS. This macro is
3617 used in assembly code, so it must not contain typecasts or
3618 integer size suffixes (e.g. "ULL").
3619
3620- CONFIG_SYS_CCSR_DO_NOT_RELOCATE:
3621 If this macro is defined, then CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS will be
3622 forced to a value that ensures that CCSR is not relocated.
3623
wdenk7f6c2cb2002-11-10 22:06:23 +00003624- Floppy Disk Support:
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003625 CONFIG_SYS_FDC_DRIVE_NUMBER
wdenk7f6c2cb2002-11-10 22:06:23 +00003626
3627 the default drive number (default value 0)
3628
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003629 CONFIG_SYS_ISA_IO_STRIDE
wdenk7f6c2cb2002-11-10 22:06:23 +00003630
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003631 defines the spacing between FDC chipset registers
wdenk7f6c2cb2002-11-10 22:06:23 +00003632 (default value 1)
3633
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003634 CONFIG_SYS_ISA_IO_OFFSET
wdenk7f6c2cb2002-11-10 22:06:23 +00003635
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00003636 defines the offset of register from address. It
3637 depends on which part of the data bus is connected to
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003638 the FDC chipset. (default value 0)
wdenk7f6c2cb2002-11-10 22:06:23 +00003639
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003640 If CONFIG_SYS_ISA_IO_STRIDE CONFIG_SYS_ISA_IO_OFFSET and
3641 CONFIG_SYS_FDC_DRIVE_NUMBER are undefined, they take their
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00003642 default value.
wdenk7f6c2cb2002-11-10 22:06:23 +00003643
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003644 if CONFIG_SYS_FDC_HW_INIT is defined, then the function
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00003645 fdc_hw_init() is called at the beginning of the FDC
3646 setup. fdc_hw_init() must be provided by the board
3647 source code. It is used to make hardware dependant
3648 initializations.
wdenk7f6c2cb2002-11-10 22:06:23 +00003649
Macpaul Lin0abddf82011-04-11 20:45:32 +00003650- CONFIG_IDE_AHB:
3651 Most IDE controllers were designed to be connected with PCI
3652 interface. Only few of them were designed for AHB interface.
3653 When software is doing ATA command and data transfer to
3654 IDE devices through IDE-AHB controller, some additional
3655 registers accessing to these kind of IDE-AHB controller
3656 is requierd.
3657
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003658- CONFIG_SYS_IMMR: Physical address of the Internal Memory.
wdenkefe2a4d2004-12-16 21:44:03 +00003659 DO NOT CHANGE unless you know exactly what you're
wdenk25d67122004-12-10 11:40:40 +00003660 doing! (11-4) [MPC8xx/82xx systems only]
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003661
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003662- CONFIG_SYS_INIT_RAM_ADDR:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003663
wdenk7152b1d2003-09-05 23:19:14 +00003664 Start address of memory area that can be used for
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003665 initial data and stack; please note that this must be
3666 writable memory that is working WITHOUT special
3667 initialization, i. e. you CANNOT use normal RAM which
3668 will become available only after programming the
3669 memory controller and running certain initialization
3670 sequences.
3671
3672 U-Boot uses the following memory types:
3673 - MPC8xx and MPC8260: IMMR (internal memory of the CPU)
3674 - MPC824X: data cache
3675 - PPC4xx: data cache
3676
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003677- CONFIG_SYS_GBL_DATA_OFFSET:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003678
3679 Offset of the initial data structure in the memory
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003680 area defined by CONFIG_SYS_INIT_RAM_ADDR. Usually
3681 CONFIG_SYS_GBL_DATA_OFFSET is chosen such that the initial
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003682 data is located at the end of the available space
Wolfgang Denk553f0982010-10-26 13:32:32 +02003683 (sometimes written as (CONFIG_SYS_INIT_RAM_SIZE -
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003684 CONFIG_SYS_INIT_DATA_SIZE), and the initial stack is just
3685 below that area (growing from (CONFIG_SYS_INIT_RAM_ADDR +
3686 CONFIG_SYS_GBL_DATA_OFFSET) downward.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003687
3688 Note:
3689 On the MPC824X (or other systems that use the data
3690 cache for initial memory) the address chosen for
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003691 CONFIG_SYS_INIT_RAM_ADDR is basically arbitrary - it must
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003692 point to an otherwise UNUSED address space between
3693 the top of RAM and the start of the PCI space.
3694
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003695- CONFIG_SYS_SIUMCR: SIU Module Configuration (11-6)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003696
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003697- CONFIG_SYS_SYPCR: System Protection Control (11-9)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003698
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003699- CONFIG_SYS_TBSCR: Time Base Status and Control (11-26)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003700
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003701- CONFIG_SYS_PISCR: Periodic Interrupt Status and Control (11-31)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003702
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003703- CONFIG_SYS_PLPRCR: PLL, Low-Power, and Reset Control Register (15-30)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003704
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003705- CONFIG_SYS_SCCR: System Clock and reset Control Register (15-27)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003706
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003707- CONFIG_SYS_OR_TIMING_SDRAM:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003708 SDRAM timing
3709
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003710- CONFIG_SYS_MAMR_PTA:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003711 periodic timer for refresh
3712
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003713- CONFIG_SYS_DER: Debug Event Register (37-47)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003714
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003715- FLASH_BASE0_PRELIM, FLASH_BASE1_PRELIM, CONFIG_SYS_REMAP_OR_AM,
3716 CONFIG_SYS_PRELIM_OR_AM, CONFIG_SYS_OR_TIMING_FLASH, CONFIG_SYS_OR0_REMAP,
3717 CONFIG_SYS_OR0_PRELIM, CONFIG_SYS_BR0_PRELIM, CONFIG_SYS_OR1_REMAP, CONFIG_SYS_OR1_PRELIM,
3718 CONFIG_SYS_BR1_PRELIM:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003719 Memory Controller Definitions: BR0/1 and OR0/1 (FLASH)
3720
3721- SDRAM_BASE2_PRELIM, SDRAM_BASE3_PRELIM, SDRAM_MAX_SIZE,
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003722 CONFIG_SYS_OR_TIMING_SDRAM, CONFIG_SYS_OR2_PRELIM, CONFIG_SYS_BR2_PRELIM,
3723 CONFIG_SYS_OR3_PRELIM, CONFIG_SYS_BR3_PRELIM:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003724 Memory Controller Definitions: BR2/3 and OR2/3 (SDRAM)
3725
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003726- CONFIG_SYS_MAMR_PTA, CONFIG_SYS_MPTPR_2BK_4K, CONFIG_SYS_MPTPR_1BK_4K, CONFIG_SYS_MPTPR_2BK_8K,
3727 CONFIG_SYS_MPTPR_1BK_8K, CONFIG_SYS_MAMR_8COL, CONFIG_SYS_MAMR_9COL:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003728 Machine Mode Register and Memory Periodic Timer
3729 Prescaler definitions (SDRAM timing)
3730
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003731- CONFIG_SYS_I2C_UCODE_PATCH, CONFIG_SYS_I2C_DPMEM_OFFSET [0x1FC0]:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003732 enable I2C microcode relocation patch (MPC8xx);
3733 define relocation offset in DPRAM [DSP2]
3734
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003735- CONFIG_SYS_SMC_UCODE_PATCH, CONFIG_SYS_SMC_DPMEM_OFFSET [0x1FC0]:
Heiko Schocherb423d052008-01-11 01:12:07 +01003736 enable SMC microcode relocation patch (MPC8xx);
3737 define relocation offset in DPRAM [SMC1]
3738
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003739- CONFIG_SYS_SPI_UCODE_PATCH, CONFIG_SYS_SPI_DPMEM_OFFSET [0x1FC0]:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003740 enable SPI microcode relocation patch (MPC8xx);
3741 define relocation offset in DPRAM [SCC4]
3742
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003743- CONFIG_SYS_USE_OSCCLK:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003744 Use OSCM clock mode on MBX8xx board. Be careful,
3745 wrong setting might damage your board. Read
3746 doc/README.MBX before setting this variable!
3747
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003748- CONFIG_SYS_CPM_POST_WORD_ADDR: (MPC8xx, MPC8260 only)
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00003749 Offset of the bootmode word in DPRAM used by post
3750 (Power On Self Tests). This definition overrides
3751 #define'd default value in commproc.h resp.
3752 cpm_8260.h.
wdenkea909b72002-11-21 23:11:29 +00003753
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003754- CONFIG_SYS_PCI_SLV_MEM_LOCAL, CONFIG_SYS_PCI_SLV_MEM_BUS, CONFIG_SYS_PICMR0_MASK_ATTRIB,
3755 CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR0_LOCAL, CONFIG_SYS_PCIMSK0_MASK, CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR1_LOCAL,
3756 CONFIG_SYS_PCIMSK1_MASK, CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR_MEM_LOCAL, CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR_MEM_BUS,
3757 CONFIG_SYS_CPU_PCI_MEM_START, CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR_MEM_SIZE, CONFIG_SYS_POCMR0_MASK_ATTRIB,
3758 CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR_MEMIO_LOCAL, CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR_MEMIO_BUS, CPU_PCI_MEMIO_START,
3759 CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR_MEMIO_SIZE, CONFIG_SYS_POCMR1_MASK_ATTRIB, CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR_IO_LOCAL,
3760 CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR_IO_BUS, CONFIG_SYS_CPU_PCI_IO_START, CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR_IO_SIZE,
3761 CONFIG_SYS_POCMR2_MASK_ATTRIB: (MPC826x only)
Stefan Roesea47a12b2010-04-15 16:07:28 +02003762 Overrides the default PCI memory map in arch/powerpc/cpu/mpc8260/pci.c if set.
wdenk5d232d02003-05-22 22:52:13 +00003763
Dirk Eibach9cacf4f2009-02-09 08:18:34 +01003764- CONFIG_PCI_DISABLE_PCIE:
3765 Disable PCI-Express on systems where it is supported but not
3766 required.
3767
Andrew Sharp69fd2d32012-08-29 14:16:32 +00003768- CONFIG_PCI_ENUM_ONLY
3769 Only scan through and get the devices on the busses.
3770 Don't do any setup work, presumably because someone or
3771 something has already done it, and we don't need to do it
3772 a second time. Useful for platforms that are pre-booted
3773 by coreboot or similar.
3774
Kumar Galaa09b9b62010-12-30 12:09:53 -06003775- CONFIG_SYS_SRIO:
3776 Chip has SRIO or not
3777
3778- CONFIG_SRIO1:
3779 Board has SRIO 1 port available
3780
3781- CONFIG_SRIO2:
3782 Board has SRIO 2 port available
3783
3784- CONFIG_SYS_SRIOn_MEM_VIRT:
3785 Virtual Address of SRIO port 'n' memory region
3786
3787- CONFIG_SYS_SRIOn_MEM_PHYS:
3788 Physical Address of SRIO port 'n' memory region
3789
3790- CONFIG_SYS_SRIOn_MEM_SIZE:
3791 Size of SRIO port 'n' memory region
3792
Alex Watermaneced4622011-05-19 15:08:36 -04003793- CONFIG_SYS_NDFC_16
3794 Defined to tell the NDFC that the NAND chip is using a
3795 16 bit bus.
3796
3797- CONFIG_SYS_NDFC_EBC0_CFG
3798 Sets the EBC0_CFG register for the NDFC. If not defined
3799 a default value will be used.
3800
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04003801- CONFIG_SPD_EEPROM
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01003802 Get DDR timing information from an I2C EEPROM. Common
3803 with pluggable memory modules such as SODIMMs
3804
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04003805 SPD_EEPROM_ADDRESS
3806 I2C address of the SPD EEPROM
3807
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003808- CONFIG_SYS_SPD_BUS_NUM
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01003809 If SPD EEPROM is on an I2C bus other than the first
3810 one, specify here. Note that the value must resolve
3811 to something your driver can deal with.
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04003812
York Sun1b3e3c42011-06-07 09:42:16 +08003813- CONFIG_SYS_DDR_RAW_TIMING
3814 Get DDR timing information from other than SPD. Common with
3815 soldered DDR chips onboard without SPD. DDR raw timing
3816 parameters are extracted from datasheet and hard-coded into
3817 header files or board specific files.
3818
York Sun6f5e1dc2011-09-16 13:21:35 -07003819- CONFIG_FSL_DDR_INTERACTIVE
3820 Enable interactive DDR debugging. See doc/README.fsl-ddr.
3821
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003822- CONFIG_SYS_83XX_DDR_USES_CS0
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01003823 Only for 83xx systems. If specified, then DDR should
3824 be configured using CS0 and CS1 instead of CS2 and CS3.
Timur Tabi2ad6b512006-10-31 18:44:42 -06003825
wdenkc26e4542004-04-18 10:13:26 +00003826- CONFIG_ETHER_ON_FEC[12]
3827 Define to enable FEC[12] on a 8xx series processor.
3828
3829- CONFIG_FEC[12]_PHY
3830 Define to the hardcoded PHY address which corresponds
wdenk6e592382004-04-18 17:39:38 +00003831 to the given FEC; i. e.
3832 #define CONFIG_FEC1_PHY 4
wdenkc26e4542004-04-18 10:13:26 +00003833 means that the PHY with address 4 is connected to FEC1
3834
3835 When set to -1, means to probe for first available.
3836
3837- CONFIG_FEC[12]_PHY_NORXERR
3838 The PHY does not have a RXERR line (RMII only).
3839 (so program the FEC to ignore it).
3840
3841- CONFIG_RMII
3842 Enable RMII mode for all FECs.
3843 Note that this is a global option, we can't
3844 have one FEC in standard MII mode and another in RMII mode.
3845
wdenk5cf91d62004-04-23 20:32:05 +00003846- CONFIG_CRC32_VERIFY
3847 Add a verify option to the crc32 command.
3848 The syntax is:
3849
3850 => crc32 -v <address> <count> <crc32>
3851
3852 Where address/count indicate a memory area
3853 and crc32 is the correct crc32 which the
3854 area should have.
3855
wdenk56523f12004-07-11 17:40:54 +00003856- CONFIG_LOOPW
3857 Add the "loopw" memory command. This only takes effect if
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05003858 the memory commands are activated globally (CONFIG_CMD_MEM).
wdenk56523f12004-07-11 17:40:54 +00003859
stroese7b466642004-12-16 18:46:55 +00003860- CONFIG_MX_CYCLIC
3861 Add the "mdc" and "mwc" memory commands. These are cyclic
3862 "md/mw" commands.
3863 Examples:
3864
wdenkefe2a4d2004-12-16 21:44:03 +00003865 => mdc.b 10 4 500
stroese7b466642004-12-16 18:46:55 +00003866 This command will print 4 bytes (10,11,12,13) each 500 ms.
3867
wdenkefe2a4d2004-12-16 21:44:03 +00003868 => mwc.l 100 12345678 10
stroese7b466642004-12-16 18:46:55 +00003869 This command will write 12345678 to address 100 all 10 ms.
3870
wdenkefe2a4d2004-12-16 21:44:03 +00003871 This only takes effect if the memory commands are activated
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05003872 globally (CONFIG_CMD_MEM).
stroese7b466642004-12-16 18:46:55 +00003873
wdenk8aa1a2d2005-04-04 12:44:11 +00003874- CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT
Macpaul Linafc1ce82011-10-19 20:41:11 +00003875 [ARM, NDS32, MIPS only] If this variable is defined, then certain
Wolfgang Denk844f07d2010-11-27 23:30:56 +01003876 low level initializations (like setting up the memory
3877 controller) are omitted and/or U-Boot does not
3878 relocate itself into RAM.
wdenk8aa1a2d2005-04-04 12:44:11 +00003879
Wolfgang Denk844f07d2010-11-27 23:30:56 +01003880 Normally this variable MUST NOT be defined. The only
3881 exception is when U-Boot is loaded (to RAM) by some
3882 other boot loader or by a debugger which performs
3883 these initializations itself.
wdenk8aa1a2d2005-04-04 12:44:11 +00003884
Aneesh V401bb302011-07-13 05:11:07 +00003885- CONFIG_SPL_BUILD
Magnus Liljadf812382009-06-13 20:50:00 +02003886 Modifies the behaviour of start.S when compiling a loader
3887 that is executed before the actual U-Boot. E.g. when
3888 compiling a NAND SPL.
wdenk400558b2005-04-02 23:52:25 +00003889
Simon Glass4213fc22013-02-24 17:33:14 +00003890- CONFIG_ARCH_MAP_SYSMEM
3891 Generally U-Boot (and in particular the md command) uses
3892 effective address. It is therefore not necessary to regard
3893 U-Boot address as virtual addresses that need to be translated
3894 to physical addresses. However, sandbox requires this, since
3895 it maintains its own little RAM buffer which contains all
3896 addressable memory. This option causes some memory accesses
3897 to be mapped through map_sysmem() / unmap_sysmem().
3898
Matthias Weisserd8834a12011-03-10 21:36:32 +00003899- CONFIG_USE_ARCH_MEMCPY
3900 CONFIG_USE_ARCH_MEMSET
3901 If these options are used a optimized version of memcpy/memset will
3902 be used if available. These functions may be faster under some
3903 conditions but may increase the binary size.
3904
Simon Glass588a13f2013-02-14 04:18:54 +00003905- CONFIG_X86_RESET_VECTOR
3906 If defined, the x86 reset vector code is included. This is not
3907 needed when U-Boot is running from Coreboot.
Gabe Blackb16f5212012-11-27 21:08:06 +00003908
Mark Jacksonfc337052013-03-04 01:27:20 +00003909- CONFIG_SYS_MPUCLK
3910 Defines the MPU clock speed (in MHz).
3911
3912 NOTE : currently only supported on AM335x platforms.
Gabe Black5b5ece92012-11-29 16:23:41 +00003913
Timur Tabif2717b42011-11-22 09:21:25 -06003914Freescale QE/FMAN Firmware Support:
3915-----------------------------------
3916
3917The Freescale QUICCEngine (QE) and Frame Manager (FMAN) both support the
3918loading of "firmware", which is encoded in the QE firmware binary format.
3919This firmware often needs to be loaded during U-Boot booting, so macros
3920are used to identify the storage device (NOR flash, SPI, etc) and the address
3921within that device.
3922
3923- CONFIG_SYS_QE_FMAN_FW_ADDR
3924 The address in the storage device where the firmware is located. The
3925 meaning of this address depends on which CONFIG_SYS_QE_FW_IN_xxx macro
3926 is also specified.
3927
3928- CONFIG_SYS_QE_FMAN_FW_LENGTH
3929 The maximum possible size of the firmware. The firmware binary format
3930 has a field that specifies the actual size of the firmware, but it
3931 might not be possible to read any part of the firmware unless some
3932 local storage is allocated to hold the entire firmware first.
3933
3934- CONFIG_SYS_QE_FMAN_FW_IN_NOR
3935 Specifies that QE/FMAN firmware is located in NOR flash, mapped as
3936 normal addressable memory via the LBC. CONFIG_SYS_FMAN_FW_ADDR is the
3937 virtual address in NOR flash.
3938
3939- CONFIG_SYS_QE_FMAN_FW_IN_NAND
3940 Specifies that QE/FMAN firmware is located in NAND flash.
3941 CONFIG_SYS_FMAN_FW_ADDR is the offset within NAND flash.
3942
3943- CONFIG_SYS_QE_FMAN_FW_IN_MMC
3944 Specifies that QE/FMAN firmware is located on the primary SD/MMC
3945 device. CONFIG_SYS_FMAN_FW_ADDR is the byte offset on that device.
3946
3947- CONFIG_SYS_QE_FMAN_FW_IN_SPIFLASH
3948 Specifies that QE/FMAN firmware is located on the primary SPI
3949 device. CONFIG_SYS_FMAN_FW_ADDR is the byte offset on that device.
3950
Liu Gang292dc6c2012-03-08 00:33:18 +00003951- CONFIG_SYS_QE_FMAN_FW_IN_REMOTE
3952 Specifies that QE/FMAN firmware is located in the remote (master)
3953 memory space. CONFIG_SYS_FMAN_FW_ADDR is a virtual address which
Liu Gangfc54c7f2012-08-09 05:10:01 +00003954 can be mapped from slave TLB->slave LAW->slave SRIO or PCIE outbound
3955 window->master inbound window->master LAW->the ucode address in
3956 master's memory space.
Timur Tabif2717b42011-11-22 09:21:25 -06003957
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003958Building the Software:
3959======================
3960
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01003961Building U-Boot has been tested in several native build environments
3962and in many different cross environments. Of course we cannot support
3963all possibly existing versions of cross development tools in all
3964(potentially obsolete) versions. In case of tool chain problems we
3965recommend to use the ELDK (see http://www.denx.de/wiki/DULG/ELDK)
3966which is extensively used to build and test U-Boot.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003967
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01003968If you are not using a native environment, it is assumed that you
3969have GNU cross compiling tools available in your path. In this case,
3970you must set the environment variable CROSS_COMPILE in your shell.
3971Note that no changes to the Makefile or any other source files are
3972necessary. For example using the ELDK on a 4xx CPU, please enter:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003973
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01003974 $ CROSS_COMPILE=ppc_4xx-
3975 $ export CROSS_COMPILE
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003976
Peter Tyser2f8d3962009-03-13 18:54:51 -05003977Note: If you wish to generate Windows versions of the utilities in
3978 the tools directory you can use the MinGW toolchain
3979 (http://www.mingw.org). Set your HOST tools to the MinGW
3980 toolchain and execute 'make tools'. For example:
3981
3982 $ make HOSTCC=i586-mingw32msvc-gcc HOSTSTRIP=i586-mingw32msvc-strip tools
3983
3984 Binaries such as tools/mkimage.exe will be created which can
3985 be executed on computers running Windows.
3986
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01003987U-Boot is intended to be simple to build. After installing the
3988sources you must configure U-Boot for one specific board type. This
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003989is done by typing:
3990
3991 make NAME_config
3992
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01003993where "NAME_config" is the name of one of the existing configu-
Michael Jones4d675ae2012-03-15 22:48:10 +00003994rations; see boards.cfg for supported names.
wdenk54387ac2003-10-08 22:45:44 +00003995
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003996Note: for some board special configuration names may exist; check if
3997 additional information is available from the board vendor; for
3998 instance, the TQM823L systems are available without (standard)
3999 or with LCD support. You can select such additional "features"
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02004000 when choosing the configuration, i. e.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004001
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004002 make TQM823L_config
4003 - will configure for a plain TQM823L, i. e. no LCD support
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004004
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004005 make TQM823L_LCD_config
4006 - will configure for a TQM823L with U-Boot console on LCD
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004007
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004008 etc.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004009
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004010
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004011Finally, type "make all", and you should get some working U-Boot
4012images ready for download to / installation on your system:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004013
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004014- "u-boot.bin" is a raw binary image
4015- "u-boot" is an image in ELF binary format
4016- "u-boot.srec" is in Motorola S-Record format
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004017
Marian Balakowiczbaf31242006-09-07 17:25:40 +02004018By default the build is performed locally and the objects are saved
4019in the source directory. One of the two methods can be used to change
4020this behavior and build U-Boot to some external directory:
4021
40221. Add O= to the make command line invocations:
4023
4024 make O=/tmp/build distclean
4025 make O=/tmp/build NAME_config
4026 make O=/tmp/build all
4027
40282. Set environment variable BUILD_DIR to point to the desired location:
4029
4030 export BUILD_DIR=/tmp/build
4031 make distclean
4032 make NAME_config
4033 make all
4034
4035Note that the command line "O=" setting overrides the BUILD_DIR environment
4036variable.
4037
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004038
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004039Please be aware that the Makefiles assume you are using GNU make, so
4040for instance on NetBSD you might need to use "gmake" instead of
4041native "make".
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004042
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004043
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004044If the system board that you have is not listed, then you will need
4045to port U-Boot to your hardware platform. To do this, follow these
4046steps:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004047
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +000040481. Add a new configuration option for your board to the toplevel
Michael Jones4d675ae2012-03-15 22:48:10 +00004049 "boards.cfg" file, using the existing entries as examples.
4050 Follow the instructions there to keep the boards in order.
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +000040512. Create a new directory to hold your board specific code. Add any
4052 files you need. In your board directory, you will need at least
4053 the "Makefile", a "<board>.c", "flash.c" and "u-boot.lds".
40543. Create a new configuration file "include/configs/<board>.h" for
4055 your board
40563. If you're porting U-Boot to a new CPU, then also create a new
4057 directory to hold your CPU specific code. Add any files you need.
40584. Run "make <board>_config" with your new name.
40595. Type "make", and you should get a working "u-boot.srec" file
4060 to be installed on your target system.
40616. Debug and solve any problems that might arise.
4062 [Of course, this last step is much harder than it sounds.]
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004063
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004064
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004065Testing of U-Boot Modifications, Ports to New Hardware, etc.:
4066==============================================================
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004067
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01004068If you have modified U-Boot sources (for instance added a new board
4069or support for new devices, a new CPU, etc.) you are expected to
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004070provide feedback to the other developers. The feedback normally takes
4071the form of a "patch", i. e. a context diff against a certain (latest
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01004072official or latest in the git repository) version of U-Boot sources.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004073
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01004074But before you submit such a patch, please verify that your modifi-
4075cation did not break existing code. At least make sure that *ALL* of
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004076the supported boards compile WITHOUT ANY compiler warnings. To do so,
4077just run the "MAKEALL" script, which will configure and build U-Boot
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01004078for ALL supported system. Be warned, this will take a while. You can
4079select which (cross) compiler to use by passing a `CROSS_COMPILE'
4080environment variable to the script, i. e. to use the ELDK cross tools
4081you can type
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004082
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004083 CROSS_COMPILE=ppc_8xx- MAKEALL
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004084
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004085or to build on a native PowerPC system you can type
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004086
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004087 CROSS_COMPILE=' ' MAKEALL
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004088
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01004089When using the MAKEALL script, the default behaviour is to build
4090U-Boot in the source directory. This location can be changed by
4091setting the BUILD_DIR environment variable. Also, for each target
4092built, the MAKEALL script saves two log files (<target>.ERR and
4093<target>.MAKEALL) in the <source dir>/LOG directory. This default
4094location can be changed by setting the MAKEALL_LOGDIR environment
4095variable. For example:
Marian Balakowiczbaf31242006-09-07 17:25:40 +02004096
4097 export BUILD_DIR=/tmp/build
4098 export MAKEALL_LOGDIR=/tmp/log
4099 CROSS_COMPILE=ppc_8xx- MAKEALL
4100
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01004101With the above settings build objects are saved in the /tmp/build,
4102log files are saved in the /tmp/log and the source tree remains clean
4103during the whole build process.
Marian Balakowiczbaf31242006-09-07 17:25:40 +02004104
4105
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004106See also "U-Boot Porting Guide" below.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004107
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004108
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004109Monitor Commands - Overview:
4110============================
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004111
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004112go - start application at address 'addr'
4113run - run commands in an environment variable
4114bootm - boot application image from memory
4115bootp - boot image via network using BootP/TFTP protocol
Marek Vasut44f074c2012-03-14 21:52:45 +00004116bootz - boot zImage from memory
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004117tftpboot- boot image via network using TFTP protocol
4118 and env variables "ipaddr" and "serverip"
4119 (and eventually "gatewayip")
Simon Glass1fb7cd42011-10-24 18:00:07 +00004120tftpput - upload a file via network using TFTP protocol
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004121rarpboot- boot image via network using RARP/TFTP protocol
4122diskboot- boot from IDE devicebootd - boot default, i.e., run 'bootcmd'
4123loads - load S-Record file over serial line
4124loadb - load binary file over serial line (kermit mode)
4125md - memory display
4126mm - memory modify (auto-incrementing)
4127nm - memory modify (constant address)
4128mw - memory write (fill)
4129cp - memory copy
4130cmp - memory compare
4131crc32 - checksum calculation
Peter Tyser0f89c542009-04-18 22:34:03 -05004132i2c - I2C sub-system
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004133sspi - SPI utility commands
4134base - print or set address offset
4135printenv- print environment variables
4136setenv - set environment variables
4137saveenv - save environment variables to persistent storage
4138protect - enable or disable FLASH write protection
4139erase - erase FLASH memory
4140flinfo - print FLASH memory information
Karl O. Pinc10635af2012-08-03 05:57:21 +00004141nand - NAND memory operations (see doc/README.nand)
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004142bdinfo - print Board Info structure
4143iminfo - print header information for application image
4144coninfo - print console devices and informations
4145ide - IDE sub-system
4146loop - infinite loop on address range
wdenk56523f12004-07-11 17:40:54 +00004147loopw - infinite write loop on address range
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004148mtest - simple RAM test
4149icache - enable or disable instruction cache
4150dcache - enable or disable data cache
4151reset - Perform RESET of the CPU
4152echo - echo args to console
4153version - print monitor version
4154help - print online help
4155? - alias for 'help'
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004156
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004157
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004158Monitor Commands - Detailed Description:
4159========================================
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004160
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004161TODO.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004162
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004163For now: just type "help <command>".
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004164
4165
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004166Environment Variables:
4167======================
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004168
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004169U-Boot supports user configuration using Environment Variables which
4170can be made persistent by saving to Flash memory.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004171
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004172Environment Variables are set using "setenv", printed using
4173"printenv", and saved to Flash using "saveenv". Using "setenv"
4174without a value can be used to delete a variable from the
4175environment. As long as you don't save the environment you are
4176working with an in-memory copy. In case the Flash area containing the
4177environment is erased by accident, a default environment is provided.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004178
Wolfgang Denkc96f86e2010-01-17 23:55:53 +01004179Some configuration options can be set using Environment Variables.
4180
4181List of environment variables (most likely not complete):
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004182
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004183 baudrate - see CONFIG_BAUDRATE
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004184
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004185 bootdelay - see CONFIG_BOOTDELAY
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004186
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004187 bootcmd - see CONFIG_BOOTCOMMAND
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004188
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004189 bootargs - Boot arguments when booting an RTOS image
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004190
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004191 bootfile - Name of the image to load with TFTP
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004192
Bartlomiej Sieka7d721e32008-04-14 15:44:16 +02004193 bootm_low - Memory range available for image processing in the bootm
4194 command can be restricted. This variable is given as
4195 a hexadecimal number and defines lowest address allowed
4196 for use by the bootm command. See also "bootm_size"
4197 environment variable. Address defined by "bootm_low" is
4198 also the base of the initial memory mapping for the Linux
Grant Likelyc3624e62011-03-28 09:58:43 +00004199 kernel -- see the description of CONFIG_SYS_BOOTMAPSZ and
4200 bootm_mapsize.
4201
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00004202 bootm_mapsize - Size of the initial memory mapping for the Linux kernel.
Grant Likelyc3624e62011-03-28 09:58:43 +00004203 This variable is given as a hexadecimal number and it
4204 defines the size of the memory region starting at base
4205 address bootm_low that is accessible by the Linux kernel
4206 during early boot. If unset, CONFIG_SYS_BOOTMAPSZ is used
4207 as the default value if it is defined, and bootm_size is
4208 used otherwise.
Bartlomiej Sieka7d721e32008-04-14 15:44:16 +02004209
4210 bootm_size - Memory range available for image processing in the bootm
4211 command can be restricted. This variable is given as
4212 a hexadecimal number and defines the size of the region
4213 allowed for use by the bootm command. See also "bootm_low"
4214 environment variable.
4215
Bartlomiej Sieka4bae9092008-10-01 15:26:31 +02004216 updatefile - Location of the software update file on a TFTP server, used
4217 by the automatic software update feature. Please refer to
4218 documentation in doc/README.update for more details.
4219
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004220 autoload - if set to "no" (any string beginning with 'n'),
4221 "bootp" will just load perform a lookup of the
4222 configuration from the BOOTP server, but not try to
4223 load any image using TFTP
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004224
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004225 autostart - if set to "yes", an image loaded using the "bootp",
4226 "rarpboot", "tftpboot" or "diskboot" commands will
4227 be automatically started (by internally calling
4228 "bootm")
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004229
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004230 If set to "no", a standalone image passed to the
4231 "bootm" command will be copied to the load address
4232 (and eventually uncompressed), but NOT be started.
4233 This can be used to load and uncompress arbitrary
4234 data.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004235
David A. Longa28afca2011-07-09 16:40:19 -04004236 fdt_high - if set this restricts the maximum address that the
4237 flattened device tree will be copied into upon boot.
Shawn Guofa34f6b2012-01-09 21:54:08 +00004238 For example, if you have a system with 1 GB memory
4239 at physical address 0x10000000, while Linux kernel
4240 only recognizes the first 704 MB as low memory, you
4241 may need to set fdt_high as 0x3C000000 to have the
4242 device tree blob be copied to the maximum address
4243 of the 704 MB low memory, so that Linux kernel can
4244 access it during the boot procedure.
4245
David A. Longa28afca2011-07-09 16:40:19 -04004246 If this is set to the special value 0xFFFFFFFF then
4247 the fdt will not be copied at all on boot. For this
4248 to work it must reside in writable memory, have
4249 sufficient padding on the end of it for u-boot to
4250 add the information it needs into it, and the memory
4251 must be accessible by the kernel.
4252
Simon Glasseea63e02011-10-24 19:15:34 +00004253 fdtcontroladdr- if set this is the address of the control flattened
4254 device tree used by U-Boot when CONFIG_OF_CONTROL is
4255 defined.
4256
wdenk17ea1172004-06-06 21:51:03 +00004257 i2cfast - (PPC405GP|PPC405EP only)
4258 if set to 'y' configures Linux I2C driver for fast
4259 mode (400kHZ). This environment variable is used in
4260 initialization code. So, for changes to be effective
4261 it must be saved and board must be reset.
4262
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004263 initrd_high - restrict positioning of initrd images:
4264 If this variable is not set, initrd images will be
4265 copied to the highest possible address in RAM; this
4266 is usually what you want since it allows for
4267 maximum initrd size. If for some reason you want to
4268 make sure that the initrd image is loaded below the
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004269 CONFIG_SYS_BOOTMAPSZ limit, you can set this environment
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004270 variable to a value of "no" or "off" or "0".
4271 Alternatively, you can set it to a maximum upper
4272 address to use (U-Boot will still check that it
4273 does not overwrite the U-Boot stack and data).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004274
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004275 For instance, when you have a system with 16 MB
4276 RAM, and want to reserve 4 MB from use by Linux,
4277 you can do this by adding "mem=12M" to the value of
4278 the "bootargs" variable. However, now you must make
4279 sure that the initrd image is placed in the first
4280 12 MB as well - this can be done with
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004281
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004282 setenv initrd_high 00c00000
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004283
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004284 If you set initrd_high to 0xFFFFFFFF, this is an
4285 indication to U-Boot that all addresses are legal
4286 for the Linux kernel, including addresses in flash
4287 memory. In this case U-Boot will NOT COPY the
4288 ramdisk at all. This may be useful to reduce the
4289 boot time on your system, but requires that this
4290 feature is supported by your Linux kernel.
wdenk4a6fd342003-04-12 23:38:12 +00004291
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004292 ipaddr - IP address; needed for tftpboot command
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004293
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004294 loadaddr - Default load address for commands like "bootp",
4295 "rarpboot", "tftpboot", "loadb" or "diskboot"
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004296
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004297 loads_echo - see CONFIG_LOADS_ECHO
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004298
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004299 serverip - TFTP server IP address; needed for tftpboot command
wdenk38b99262003-05-23 23:18:21 +00004300
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004301 bootretry - see CONFIG_BOOT_RETRY_TIME
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004302
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004303 bootdelaykey - see CONFIG_AUTOBOOT_DELAY_STR
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004304
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004305 bootstopkey - see CONFIG_AUTOBOOT_STOP_STR
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004306
Mike Frysingere2a53452011-10-02 10:01:27 +00004307 ethprime - controls which interface is used first.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004308
Mike Frysingere2a53452011-10-02 10:01:27 +00004309 ethact - controls which interface is currently active.
4310 For example you can do the following
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004311
Heiko Schocher48690d82010-07-20 17:45:02 +02004312 => setenv ethact FEC
4313 => ping 192.168.0.1 # traffic sent on FEC
4314 => setenv ethact SCC
4315 => ping 10.0.0.1 # traffic sent on SCC
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004316
Matthias Fuchse1692572008-01-17 07:45:05 +01004317 ethrotate - When set to "no" U-Boot does not go through all
4318 available network interfaces.
4319 It just stays at the currently selected interface.
4320
Wolfgang Denkc96f86e2010-01-17 23:55:53 +01004321 netretry - When set to "no" each network operation will
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004322 either succeed or fail without retrying.
4323 When set to "once" the network operation will
4324 fail when all the available network interfaces
4325 are tried once without success.
4326 Useful on scripts which control the retry operation
4327 themselves.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004328
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARDb4e2f892009-01-31 09:53:39 +01004329 npe_ucode - set load address for the NPE microcode
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARDa1cf0272008-01-07 08:41:34 +01004330
Wolfgang Denk28cb9372005-09-24 23:25:46 +02004331 tftpsrcport - If this is set, the value is used for TFTP's
Wolfgang Denkecb0ccd2005-09-24 22:37:32 +02004332 UDP source port.
4333
Wolfgang Denk28cb9372005-09-24 23:25:46 +02004334 tftpdstport - If this is set, the value is used for TFTP's UDP
4335 destination port instead of the Well Know Port 69.
4336
Wolfgang Denkc96f86e2010-01-17 23:55:53 +01004337 tftpblocksize - Block size to use for TFTP transfers; if not set,
4338 we use the TFTP server's default block size
4339
4340 tftptimeout - Retransmission timeout for TFTP packets (in milli-
4341 seconds, minimum value is 1000 = 1 second). Defines
4342 when a packet is considered to be lost so it has to
4343 be retransmitted. The default is 5000 = 5 seconds.
4344 Lowering this value may make downloads succeed
4345 faster in networks with high packet loss rates or
4346 with unreliable TFTP servers.
4347
4348 vlan - When set to a value < 4095 the traffic over
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02004349 Ethernet is encapsulated/received over 802.1q
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004350 VLAN tagged frames.
wdenka3d991b2004-04-15 21:48:45 +00004351
Jason Hobbsdc0b7b02011-08-31 05:37:28 +00004352The following image location variables contain the location of images
4353used in booting. The "Image" column gives the role of the image and is
4354not an environment variable name. The other columns are environment
4355variable names. "File Name" gives the name of the file on a TFTP
4356server, "RAM Address" gives the location in RAM the image will be
4357loaded to, and "Flash Location" gives the image's address in NOR
4358flash or offset in NAND flash.
4359
4360*Note* - these variables don't have to be defined for all boards, some
4361boards currenlty use other variables for these purposes, and some
4362boards use these variables for other purposes.
4363
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00004364Image File Name RAM Address Flash Location
4365----- --------- ----------- --------------
4366u-boot u-boot u-boot_addr_r u-boot_addr
4367Linux kernel bootfile kernel_addr_r kernel_addr
4368device tree blob fdtfile fdt_addr_r fdt_addr
4369ramdisk ramdiskfile ramdisk_addr_r ramdisk_addr
Jason Hobbsdc0b7b02011-08-31 05:37:28 +00004370
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004371The following environment variables may be used and automatically
4372updated by the network boot commands ("bootp" and "rarpboot"),
4373depending the information provided by your boot server:
wdenka3d991b2004-04-15 21:48:45 +00004374
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004375 bootfile - see above
4376 dnsip - IP address of your Domain Name Server
4377 dnsip2 - IP address of your secondary Domain Name Server
4378 gatewayip - IP address of the Gateway (Router) to use
4379 hostname - Target hostname
4380 ipaddr - see above
4381 netmask - Subnet Mask
4382 rootpath - Pathname of the root filesystem on the NFS server
4383 serverip - see above
wdenka3d991b2004-04-15 21:48:45 +00004384
wdenka3d991b2004-04-15 21:48:45 +00004385
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004386There are two special Environment Variables:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004387
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004388 serial# - contains hardware identification information such
4389 as type string and/or serial number
4390 ethaddr - Ethernet address
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004391
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004392These variables can be set only once (usually during manufacturing of
4393the board). U-Boot refuses to delete or overwrite these variables
4394once they have been set once.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004395
4396
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004397Further special Environment Variables:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004398
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004399 ver - Contains the U-Boot version string as printed
4400 with the "version" command. This variable is
4401 readonly (see CONFIG_VERSION_VARIABLE).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004402
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004403
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004404Please note that changes to some configuration parameters may take
4405only effect after the next boot (yes, that's just like Windoze :-).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004406
stroesec1551ea2003-04-04 15:53:41 +00004407
Joe Hershberger170ab112012-12-11 22:16:24 -06004408Callback functions for environment variables:
4409---------------------------------------------
4410
4411For some environment variables, the behavior of u-boot needs to change
4412when their values are changed. This functionailty allows functions to
4413be associated with arbitrary variables. On creation, overwrite, or
4414deletion, the callback will provide the opportunity for some side
4415effect to happen or for the change to be rejected.
4416
4417The callbacks are named and associated with a function using the
4418U_BOOT_ENV_CALLBACK macro in your board or driver code.
4419
4420These callbacks are associated with variables in one of two ways. The
4421static list can be added to by defining CONFIG_ENV_CALLBACK_LIST_STATIC
4422in the board configuration to a string that defines a list of
4423associations. The list must be in the following format:
4424
4425 entry = variable_name[:callback_name]
4426 list = entry[,list]
4427
4428If the callback name is not specified, then the callback is deleted.
4429Spaces are also allowed anywhere in the list.
4430
4431Callbacks can also be associated by defining the ".callbacks" variable
4432with the same list format above. Any association in ".callbacks" will
4433override any association in the static list. You can define
4434CONFIG_ENV_CALLBACK_LIST_DEFAULT to a list (string) to define the
4435".callbacks" envirnoment variable in the default or embedded environment.
4436
4437
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004438Command Line Parsing:
4439=====================
stroesec1551ea2003-04-04 15:53:41 +00004440
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004441There are two different command line parsers available with U-Boot:
4442the old "simple" one, and the much more powerful "hush" shell:
stroesec1551ea2003-04-04 15:53:41 +00004443
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004444Old, simple command line parser:
4445--------------------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004446
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004447- supports environment variables (through setenv / saveenv commands)
4448- several commands on one line, separated by ';'
Wolfgang Denkfe126d82005-11-20 21:40:11 +01004449- variable substitution using "... ${name} ..." syntax
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004450- special characters ('$', ';') can be escaped by prefixing with '\',
4451 for example:
Wolfgang Denkfe126d82005-11-20 21:40:11 +01004452 setenv bootcmd bootm \${address}
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004453- You can also escape text by enclosing in single apostrophes, for example:
4454 setenv addip 'setenv bootargs $bootargs ip=$ipaddr:$serverip:$gatewayip:$netmask:$hostname::off'
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004455
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004456Hush shell:
4457-----------
wdenkf07771c2003-05-28 08:06:31 +00004458
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004459- similar to Bourne shell, with control structures like
4460 if...then...else...fi, for...do...done; while...do...done,
4461 until...do...done, ...
4462- supports environment ("global") variables (through setenv / saveenv
4463 commands) and local shell variables (through standard shell syntax
4464 "name=value"); only environment variables can be used with "run"
4465 command
wdenkf07771c2003-05-28 08:06:31 +00004466
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004467General rules:
4468--------------
wdenkf07771c2003-05-28 08:06:31 +00004469
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004470(1) If a command line (or an environment variable executed by a "run"
4471 command) contains several commands separated by semicolon, and
4472 one of these commands fails, then the remaining commands will be
4473 executed anyway.
wdenkf07771c2003-05-28 08:06:31 +00004474
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004475(2) If you execute several variables with one call to run (i. e.
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02004476 calling run with a list of variables as arguments), any failing
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004477 command will cause "run" to terminate, i. e. the remaining
4478 variables are not executed.
wdenkf07771c2003-05-28 08:06:31 +00004479
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004480Note for Redundant Ethernet Interfaces:
4481=======================================
wdenkf07771c2003-05-28 08:06:31 +00004482
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02004483Some boards come with redundant Ethernet interfaces; U-Boot supports
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004484such configurations and is capable of automatic selection of a
4485"working" interface when needed. MAC assignment works as follows:
wdenkf07771c2003-05-28 08:06:31 +00004486
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004487Network interfaces are numbered eth0, eth1, eth2, ... Corresponding
4488MAC addresses can be stored in the environment as "ethaddr" (=>eth0),
4489"eth1addr" (=>eth1), "eth2addr", ...
wdenkf07771c2003-05-28 08:06:31 +00004490
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004491If the network interface stores some valid MAC address (for instance
4492in SROM), this is used as default address if there is NO correspon-
4493ding setting in the environment; if the corresponding environment
4494variable is set, this overrides the settings in the card; that means:
wdenkf07771c2003-05-28 08:06:31 +00004495
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004496o If the SROM has a valid MAC address, and there is no address in the
4497 environment, the SROM's address is used.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004498
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004499o If there is no valid address in the SROM, and a definition in the
4500 environment exists, then the value from the environment variable is
4501 used.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004502
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004503o If both the SROM and the environment contain a MAC address, and
4504 both addresses are the same, this MAC address is used.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004505
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004506o If both the SROM and the environment contain a MAC address, and the
4507 addresses differ, the value from the environment is used and a
4508 warning is printed.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004509
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004510o If neither SROM nor the environment contain a MAC address, an error
4511 is raised.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004512
Ben Warrenecee9322010-04-26 11:11:46 -07004513If Ethernet drivers implement the 'write_hwaddr' function, valid MAC addresses
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00004514will be programmed into hardware as part of the initialization process. This
Ben Warrenecee9322010-04-26 11:11:46 -07004515may be skipped by setting the appropriate 'ethmacskip' environment variable.
4516The naming convention is as follows:
4517"ethmacskip" (=>eth0), "eth1macskip" (=>eth1) etc.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004518
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004519Image Formats:
4520==============
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004521
Marian Balakowicz3310c542008-03-12 12:13:13 +01004522U-Boot is capable of booting (and performing other auxiliary operations on)
4523images in two formats:
4524
4525New uImage format (FIT)
4526-----------------------
4527
4528Flexible and powerful format based on Flattened Image Tree -- FIT (similar
4529to Flattened Device Tree). It allows the use of images with multiple
4530components (several kernels, ramdisks, etc.), with contents protected by
4531SHA1, MD5 or CRC32. More details are found in the doc/uImage.FIT directory.
4532
4533
4534Old uImage format
4535-----------------
4536
4537Old image format is based on binary files which can be basically anything,
4538preceded by a special header; see the definitions in include/image.h for
4539details; basically, the header defines the following image properties:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004540
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004541* Target Operating System (Provisions for OpenBSD, NetBSD, FreeBSD,
4542 4.4BSD, Linux, SVR4, Esix, Solaris, Irix, SCO, Dell, NCR, VxWorks,
Peter Tyserf5ed9e32008-09-08 14:56:49 -05004543 LynxOS, pSOS, QNX, RTEMS, INTEGRITY;
4544 Currently supported: Linux, NetBSD, VxWorks, QNX, RTEMS, LynxOS,
4545 INTEGRITY).
Wolfgang Denk7b64fef2006-10-24 14:21:16 +02004546* Target CPU Architecture (Provisions for Alpha, ARM, AVR32, Intel x86,
Macpaul Linafc1ce82011-10-19 20:41:11 +00004547 IA64, MIPS, NDS32, Nios II, PowerPC, IBM S390, SuperH, Sparc, Sparc 64 Bit;
4548 Currently supported: ARM, AVR32, Intel x86, MIPS, NDS32, Nios II, PowerPC).
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004549* Compression Type (uncompressed, gzip, bzip2)
4550* Load Address
4551* Entry Point
4552* Image Name
4553* Image Timestamp
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004554
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004555The header is marked by a special Magic Number, and both the header
4556and the data portions of the image are secured against corruption by
4557CRC32 checksums.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004558
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004559
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004560Linux Support:
4561==============
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004562
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004563Although U-Boot should support any OS or standalone application
4564easily, the main focus has always been on Linux during the design of
4565U-Boot.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004566
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004567U-Boot includes many features that so far have been part of some
4568special "boot loader" code within the Linux kernel. Also, any
4569"initrd" images to be used are no longer part of one big Linux image;
4570instead, kernel and "initrd" are separate images. This implementation
4571serves several purposes:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004572
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004573- the same features can be used for other OS or standalone
4574 applications (for instance: using compressed images to reduce the
4575 Flash memory footprint)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004576
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004577- it becomes much easier to port new Linux kernel versions because
4578 lots of low-level, hardware dependent stuff are done by U-Boot
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004579
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004580- the same Linux kernel image can now be used with different "initrd"
4581 images; of course this also means that different kernel images can
4582 be run with the same "initrd". This makes testing easier (you don't
4583 have to build a new "zImage.initrd" Linux image when you just
4584 change a file in your "initrd"). Also, a field-upgrade of the
4585 software is easier now.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004586
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004587
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004588Linux HOWTO:
4589============
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004590
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004591Porting Linux to U-Boot based systems:
4592---------------------------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004593
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004594U-Boot cannot save you from doing all the necessary modifications to
4595configure the Linux device drivers for use with your target hardware
4596(no, we don't intend to provide a full virtual machine interface to
4597Linux :-).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004598
Stefan Roesea47a12b2010-04-15 16:07:28 +02004599But now you can ignore ALL boot loader code (in arch/powerpc/mbxboot).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004600
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004601Just make sure your machine specific header file (for instance
4602include/asm-ppc/tqm8xx.h) includes the same definition of the Board
Markus Heidelberg1dc30692008-09-07 20:18:27 +02004603Information structure as we define in include/asm-<arch>/u-boot.h,
4604and make sure that your definition of IMAP_ADDR uses the same value
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004605as your U-Boot configuration in CONFIG_SYS_IMMR.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004606
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004607
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004608Configuring the Linux kernel:
4609-----------------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004610
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004611No specific requirements for U-Boot. Make sure you have some root
4612device (initial ramdisk, NFS) for your target system.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004613
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004614
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004615Building a Linux Image:
4616-----------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004617
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004618With U-Boot, "normal" build targets like "zImage" or "bzImage" are
4619not used. If you use recent kernel source, a new build target
4620"uImage" will exist which automatically builds an image usable by
4621U-Boot. Most older kernels also have support for a "pImage" target,
4622which was introduced for our predecessor project PPCBoot and uses a
4623100% compatible format.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004624
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004625Example:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004626
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004627 make TQM850L_config
4628 make oldconfig
4629 make dep
4630 make uImage
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004631
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004632The "uImage" build target uses a special tool (in 'tools/mkimage') to
4633encapsulate a compressed Linux kernel image with header information,
4634CRC32 checksum etc. for use with U-Boot. This is what we are doing:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004635
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004636* build a standard "vmlinux" kernel image (in ELF binary format):
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004637
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004638* convert the kernel into a raw binary image:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004639
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004640 ${CROSS_COMPILE}-objcopy -O binary \
4641 -R .note -R .comment \
4642 -S vmlinux linux.bin
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004643
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004644* compress the binary image:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004645
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004646 gzip -9 linux.bin
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004647
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004648* package compressed binary image for U-Boot:
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00004649
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004650 mkimage -A ppc -O linux -T kernel -C gzip \
4651 -a 0 -e 0 -n "Linux Kernel Image" \
4652 -d linux.bin.gz uImage
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00004653
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00004654
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004655The "mkimage" tool can also be used to create ramdisk images for use
4656with U-Boot, either separated from the Linux kernel image, or
4657combined into one file. "mkimage" encapsulates the images with a 64
4658byte header containing information about target architecture,
4659operating system, image type, compression method, entry points, time
4660stamp, CRC32 checksums, etc.
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00004661
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004662"mkimage" can be called in two ways: to verify existing images and
4663print the header information, or to build new images.
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00004664
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004665In the first form (with "-l" option) mkimage lists the information
4666contained in the header of an existing U-Boot image; this includes
4667checksum verification:
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00004668
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004669 tools/mkimage -l image
4670 -l ==> list image header information
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00004671
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004672The second form (with "-d" option) is used to build a U-Boot image
4673from a "data file" which is used as image payload:
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00004674
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004675 tools/mkimage -A arch -O os -T type -C comp -a addr -e ep \
4676 -n name -d data_file image
4677 -A ==> set architecture to 'arch'
4678 -O ==> set operating system to 'os'
4679 -T ==> set image type to 'type'
4680 -C ==> set compression type 'comp'
4681 -a ==> set load address to 'addr' (hex)
4682 -e ==> set entry point to 'ep' (hex)
4683 -n ==> set image name to 'name'
4684 -d ==> use image data from 'datafile'
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00004685
wdenk69459792004-05-29 16:53:29 +00004686Right now, all Linux kernels for PowerPC systems use the same load
4687address (0x00000000), but the entry point address depends on the
4688kernel version:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004689
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004690- 2.2.x kernels have the entry point at 0x0000000C,
4691- 2.3.x and later kernels have the entry point at 0x00000000.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004692
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004693So a typical call to build a U-Boot image would read:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004694
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004695 -> tools/mkimage -n '2.4.4 kernel for TQM850L' \
4696 > -A ppc -O linux -T kernel -C gzip -a 0 -e 0 \
Stefan Roesea47a12b2010-04-15 16:07:28 +02004697 > -d /opt/elsk/ppc_8xx/usr/src/linux-2.4.4/arch/powerpc/coffboot/vmlinux.gz \
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004698 > examples/uImage.TQM850L
4699 Image Name: 2.4.4 kernel for TQM850L
4700 Created: Wed Jul 19 02:34:59 2000
4701 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (gzip compressed)
4702 Data Size: 335725 Bytes = 327.86 kB = 0.32 MB
4703 Load Address: 0x00000000
4704 Entry Point: 0x00000000
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004705
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004706To verify the contents of the image (or check for corruption):
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004707
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004708 -> tools/mkimage -l examples/uImage.TQM850L
4709 Image Name: 2.4.4 kernel for TQM850L
4710 Created: Wed Jul 19 02:34:59 2000
4711 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (gzip compressed)
4712 Data Size: 335725 Bytes = 327.86 kB = 0.32 MB
4713 Load Address: 0x00000000
4714 Entry Point: 0x00000000
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004715
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004716NOTE: for embedded systems where boot time is critical you can trade
4717speed for memory and install an UNCOMPRESSED image instead: this
4718needs more space in Flash, but boots much faster since it does not
4719need to be uncompressed:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004720
Stefan Roesea47a12b2010-04-15 16:07:28 +02004721 -> gunzip /opt/elsk/ppc_8xx/usr/src/linux-2.4.4/arch/powerpc/coffboot/vmlinux.gz
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004722 -> tools/mkimage -n '2.4.4 kernel for TQM850L' \
4723 > -A ppc -O linux -T kernel -C none -a 0 -e 0 \
Stefan Roesea47a12b2010-04-15 16:07:28 +02004724 > -d /opt/elsk/ppc_8xx/usr/src/linux-2.4.4/arch/powerpc/coffboot/vmlinux \
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004725 > examples/uImage.TQM850L-uncompressed
4726 Image Name: 2.4.4 kernel for TQM850L
4727 Created: Wed Jul 19 02:34:59 2000
4728 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (uncompressed)
4729 Data Size: 792160 Bytes = 773.59 kB = 0.76 MB
4730 Load Address: 0x00000000
4731 Entry Point: 0x00000000
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004732
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004733
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004734Similar you can build U-Boot images from a 'ramdisk.image.gz' file
4735when your kernel is intended to use an initial ramdisk:
wdenkdb01a2e2004-04-15 23:14:49 +00004736
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004737 -> tools/mkimage -n 'Simple Ramdisk Image' \
4738 > -A ppc -O linux -T ramdisk -C gzip \
4739 > -d /LinuxPPC/images/SIMPLE-ramdisk.image.gz examples/simple-initrd
4740 Image Name: Simple Ramdisk Image
4741 Created: Wed Jan 12 14:01:50 2000
4742 Image Type: PowerPC Linux RAMDisk Image (gzip compressed)
4743 Data Size: 566530 Bytes = 553.25 kB = 0.54 MB
4744 Load Address: 0x00000000
4745 Entry Point: 0x00000000
wdenkdb01a2e2004-04-15 23:14:49 +00004746
wdenkdb01a2e2004-04-15 23:14:49 +00004747
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004748Installing a Linux Image:
4749-------------------------
wdenkdb01a2e2004-04-15 23:14:49 +00004750
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004751To downloading a U-Boot image over the serial (console) interface,
4752you must convert the image to S-Record format:
wdenkdb01a2e2004-04-15 23:14:49 +00004753
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004754 objcopy -I binary -O srec examples/image examples/image.srec
wdenkdb01a2e2004-04-15 23:14:49 +00004755
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004756The 'objcopy' does not understand the information in the U-Boot
4757image header, so the resulting S-Record file will be relative to
4758address 0x00000000. To load it to a given address, you need to
4759specify the target address as 'offset' parameter with the 'loads'
4760command.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004761
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004762Example: install the image to address 0x40100000 (which on the
4763TQM8xxL is in the first Flash bank):
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004764
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004765 => erase 40100000 401FFFFF
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004766
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004767 .......... done
4768 Erased 8 sectors
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004769
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004770 => loads 40100000
4771 ## Ready for S-Record download ...
4772 ~>examples/image.srec
4773 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 ...
4774 ...
4775 15989 15990 15991 15992
4776 [file transfer complete]
4777 [connected]
4778 ## Start Addr = 0x00000000
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004779
4780
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004781You can check the success of the download using the 'iminfo' command;
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01004782this includes a checksum verification so you can be sure no data
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004783corruption happened:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004784
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004785 => imi 40100000
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004786
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004787 ## Checking Image at 40100000 ...
4788 Image Name: 2.2.13 for initrd on TQM850L
4789 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (gzip compressed)
4790 Data Size: 335725 Bytes = 327 kB = 0 MB
4791 Load Address: 00000000
4792 Entry Point: 0000000c
4793 Verifying Checksum ... OK
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004794
4795
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004796Boot Linux:
4797-----------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004798
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004799The "bootm" command is used to boot an application that is stored in
4800memory (RAM or Flash). In case of a Linux kernel image, the contents
4801of the "bootargs" environment variable is passed to the kernel as
4802parameters. You can check and modify this variable using the
4803"printenv" and "setenv" commands:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004804
4805
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004806 => printenv bootargs
4807 bootargs=root=/dev/ram
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004808
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004809 => setenv bootargs root=/dev/nfs rw nfsroot=10.0.0.2:/LinuxPPC nfsaddrs=10.0.0.99:10.0.0.2
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004810
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004811 => printenv bootargs
4812 bootargs=root=/dev/nfs rw nfsroot=10.0.0.2:/LinuxPPC nfsaddrs=10.0.0.99:10.0.0.2
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004813
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004814 => bootm 40020000
4815 ## Booting Linux kernel at 40020000 ...
4816 Image Name: 2.2.13 for NFS on TQM850L
4817 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (gzip compressed)
4818 Data Size: 381681 Bytes = 372 kB = 0 MB
4819 Load Address: 00000000
4820 Entry Point: 0000000c
4821 Verifying Checksum ... OK
4822 Uncompressing Kernel Image ... OK
4823 Linux version 2.2.13 (wd@denx.local.net) (gcc version 2.95.2 19991024 (release)) #1 Wed Jul 19 02:35:17 MEST 2000
4824 Boot arguments: root=/dev/nfs rw nfsroot=10.0.0.2:/LinuxPPC nfsaddrs=10.0.0.99:10.0.0.2
4825 time_init: decrementer frequency = 187500000/60
4826 Calibrating delay loop... 49.77 BogoMIPS
4827 Memory: 15208k available (700k kernel code, 444k data, 32k init) [c0000000,c1000000]
4828 ...
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004829
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02004830If you want to boot a Linux kernel with initial RAM disk, you pass
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004831the memory addresses of both the kernel and the initrd image (PPBCOOT
4832format!) to the "bootm" command:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004833
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004834 => imi 40100000 40200000
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004835
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004836 ## Checking Image at 40100000 ...
4837 Image Name: 2.2.13 for initrd on TQM850L
4838 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (gzip compressed)
4839 Data Size: 335725 Bytes = 327 kB = 0 MB
4840 Load Address: 00000000
4841 Entry Point: 0000000c
4842 Verifying Checksum ... OK
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004843
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004844 ## Checking Image at 40200000 ...
4845 Image Name: Simple Ramdisk Image
4846 Image Type: PowerPC Linux RAMDisk Image (gzip compressed)
4847 Data Size: 566530 Bytes = 553 kB = 0 MB
4848 Load Address: 00000000
4849 Entry Point: 00000000
4850 Verifying Checksum ... OK
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004851
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004852 => bootm 40100000 40200000
4853 ## Booting Linux kernel at 40100000 ...
4854 Image Name: 2.2.13 for initrd on TQM850L
4855 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (gzip compressed)
4856 Data Size: 335725 Bytes = 327 kB = 0 MB
4857 Load Address: 00000000
4858 Entry Point: 0000000c
4859 Verifying Checksum ... OK
4860 Uncompressing Kernel Image ... OK
4861 ## Loading RAMDisk Image at 40200000 ...
4862 Image Name: Simple Ramdisk Image
4863 Image Type: PowerPC Linux RAMDisk Image (gzip compressed)
4864 Data Size: 566530 Bytes = 553 kB = 0 MB
4865 Load Address: 00000000
4866 Entry Point: 00000000
4867 Verifying Checksum ... OK
4868 Loading Ramdisk ... OK
4869 Linux version 2.2.13 (wd@denx.local.net) (gcc version 2.95.2 19991024 (release)) #1 Wed Jul 19 02:32:08 MEST 2000
4870 Boot arguments: root=/dev/ram
4871 time_init: decrementer frequency = 187500000/60
4872 Calibrating delay loop... 49.77 BogoMIPS
4873 ...
4874 RAMDISK: Compressed image found at block 0
4875 VFS: Mounted root (ext2 filesystem).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004876
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004877 bash#
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004878
Matthew McClintock02677682006-06-28 10:41:37 -05004879Boot Linux and pass a flat device tree:
4880-----------
4881
4882First, U-Boot must be compiled with the appropriate defines. See the section
4883titled "Linux Kernel Interface" above for a more in depth explanation. The
4884following is an example of how to start a kernel and pass an updated
4885flat device tree:
4886
4887=> print oftaddr
4888oftaddr=0x300000
4889=> print oft
4890oft=oftrees/mpc8540ads.dtb
4891=> tftp $oftaddr $oft
4892Speed: 1000, full duplex
4893Using TSEC0 device
4894TFTP from server 192.168.1.1; our IP address is 192.168.1.101
4895Filename 'oftrees/mpc8540ads.dtb'.
4896Load address: 0x300000
4897Loading: #
4898done
4899Bytes transferred = 4106 (100a hex)
4900=> tftp $loadaddr $bootfile
4901Speed: 1000, full duplex
4902Using TSEC0 device
4903TFTP from server 192.168.1.1; our IP address is 192.168.1.2
4904Filename 'uImage'.
4905Load address: 0x200000
4906Loading:############
4907done
4908Bytes transferred = 1029407 (fb51f hex)
4909=> print loadaddr
4910loadaddr=200000
4911=> print oftaddr
4912oftaddr=0x300000
4913=> bootm $loadaddr - $oftaddr
4914## Booting image at 00200000 ...
Wolfgang Denka9398e02006-11-27 15:32:42 +01004915 Image Name: Linux-2.6.17-dirty
4916 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (gzip compressed)
4917 Data Size: 1029343 Bytes = 1005.2 kB
Matthew McClintock02677682006-06-28 10:41:37 -05004918 Load Address: 00000000
Wolfgang Denka9398e02006-11-27 15:32:42 +01004919 Entry Point: 00000000
Matthew McClintock02677682006-06-28 10:41:37 -05004920 Verifying Checksum ... OK
4921 Uncompressing Kernel Image ... OK
4922Booting using flat device tree at 0x300000
4923Using MPC85xx ADS machine description
4924Memory CAM mapping: CAM0=256Mb, CAM1=256Mb, CAM2=0Mb residual: 0Mb
4925[snip]
4926
4927
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004928More About U-Boot Image Types:
4929------------------------------
wdenk6069ff22003-02-28 00:49:47 +00004930
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004931U-Boot supports the following image types:
wdenk6069ff22003-02-28 00:49:47 +00004932
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004933 "Standalone Programs" are directly runnable in the environment
4934 provided by U-Boot; it is expected that (if they behave
4935 well) you can continue to work in U-Boot after return from
4936 the Standalone Program.
4937 "OS Kernel Images" are usually images of some Embedded OS which
4938 will take over control completely. Usually these programs
4939 will install their own set of exception handlers, device
4940 drivers, set up the MMU, etc. - this means, that you cannot
4941 expect to re-enter U-Boot except by resetting the CPU.
4942 "RAMDisk Images" are more or less just data blocks, and their
4943 parameters (address, size) are passed to an OS kernel that is
4944 being started.
4945 "Multi-File Images" contain several images, typically an OS
4946 (Linux) kernel image and one or more data images like
4947 RAMDisks. This construct is useful for instance when you want
4948 to boot over the network using BOOTP etc., where the boot
4949 server provides just a single image file, but you want to get
4950 for instance an OS kernel and a RAMDisk image.
stroesec1551ea2003-04-04 15:53:41 +00004951
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004952 "Multi-File Images" start with a list of image sizes, each
4953 image size (in bytes) specified by an "uint32_t" in network
4954 byte order. This list is terminated by an "(uint32_t)0".
4955 Immediately after the terminating 0 follow the images, one by
4956 one, all aligned on "uint32_t" boundaries (size rounded up to
4957 a multiple of 4 bytes).
stroesec1551ea2003-04-04 15:53:41 +00004958
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004959 "Firmware Images" are binary images containing firmware (like
4960 U-Boot or FPGA images) which usually will be programmed to
4961 flash memory.
stroesec1551ea2003-04-04 15:53:41 +00004962
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004963 "Script files" are command sequences that will be executed by
4964 U-Boot's command interpreter; this feature is especially
4965 useful when you configure U-Boot to use a real shell (hush)
4966 as command interpreter.
wdenk6069ff22003-02-28 00:49:47 +00004967
Marek Vasut44f074c2012-03-14 21:52:45 +00004968Booting the Linux zImage:
4969-------------------------
4970
4971On some platforms, it's possible to boot Linux zImage. This is done
4972using the "bootz" command. The syntax of "bootz" command is the same
4973as the syntax of "bootm" command.
4974
Marek Vasut017e1f32012-03-18 11:47:58 +00004975Note, defining the CONFIG_SUPPORT_INITRD_RAW allows user to supply
4976kernel with raw initrd images. The syntax is slightly different, the
4977address of the initrd must be augmented by it's size, in the following
4978format: "<initrd addres>:<initrd size>".
4979
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004980
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004981Standalone HOWTO:
4982=================
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004983
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004984One of the features of U-Boot is that you can dynamically load and
4985run "standalone" applications, which can use some resources of
4986U-Boot like console I/O functions or interrupt services.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004987
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004988Two simple examples are included with the sources:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004989
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004990"Hello World" Demo:
4991-------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004992
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004993'examples/hello_world.c' contains a small "Hello World" Demo
4994application; it is automatically compiled when you build U-Boot.
4995It's configured to run at address 0x00040004, so you can play with it
4996like that:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004997
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004998 => loads
4999 ## Ready for S-Record download ...
5000 ~>examples/hello_world.srec
5001 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 ...
5002 [file transfer complete]
5003 [connected]
5004 ## Start Addr = 0x00040004
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005005
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005006 => go 40004 Hello World! This is a test.
5007 ## Starting application at 0x00040004 ...
5008 Hello World
5009 argc = 7
5010 argv[0] = "40004"
5011 argv[1] = "Hello"
5012 argv[2] = "World!"
5013 argv[3] = "This"
5014 argv[4] = "is"
5015 argv[5] = "a"
5016 argv[6] = "test."
5017 argv[7] = "<NULL>"
5018 Hit any key to exit ...
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005019
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005020 ## Application terminated, rc = 0x0
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005021
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005022Another example, which demonstrates how to register a CPM interrupt
5023handler with the U-Boot code, can be found in 'examples/timer.c'.
5024Here, a CPM timer is set up to generate an interrupt every second.
5025The interrupt service routine is trivial, just printing a '.'
5026character, but this is just a demo program. The application can be
5027controlled by the following keys:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005028
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005029 ? - print current values og the CPM Timer registers
5030 b - enable interrupts and start timer
5031 e - stop timer and disable interrupts
5032 q - quit application
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005033
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005034 => loads
5035 ## Ready for S-Record download ...
5036 ~>examples/timer.srec
5037 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 ...
5038 [file transfer complete]
5039 [connected]
5040 ## Start Addr = 0x00040004
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005041
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005042 => go 40004
5043 ## Starting application at 0x00040004 ...
5044 TIMERS=0xfff00980
5045 Using timer 1
5046 tgcr @ 0xfff00980, tmr @ 0xfff00990, trr @ 0xfff00994, tcr @ 0xfff00998, tcn @ 0xfff0099c, ter @ 0xfff009b0
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005047
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005048Hit 'b':
5049 [q, b, e, ?] Set interval 1000000 us
5050 Enabling timer
5051Hit '?':
5052 [q, b, e, ?] ........
5053 tgcr=0x1, tmr=0xff1c, trr=0x3d09, tcr=0x0, tcn=0xef6, ter=0x0
5054Hit '?':
5055 [q, b, e, ?] .
5056 tgcr=0x1, tmr=0xff1c, trr=0x3d09, tcr=0x0, tcn=0x2ad4, ter=0x0
5057Hit '?':
5058 [q, b, e, ?] .
5059 tgcr=0x1, tmr=0xff1c, trr=0x3d09, tcr=0x0, tcn=0x1efc, ter=0x0
5060Hit '?':
5061 [q, b, e, ?] .
5062 tgcr=0x1, tmr=0xff1c, trr=0x3d09, tcr=0x0, tcn=0x169d, ter=0x0
5063Hit 'e':
5064 [q, b, e, ?] ...Stopping timer
5065Hit 'q':
5066 [q, b, e, ?] ## Application terminated, rc = 0x0
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005067
5068
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005069Minicom warning:
5070================
wdenk85ec0bc2003-03-31 16:34:49 +00005071
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005072Over time, many people have reported problems when trying to use the
5073"minicom" terminal emulation program for serial download. I (wd)
5074consider minicom to be broken, and recommend not to use it. Under
5075Unix, I recommend to use C-Kermit for general purpose use (and
5076especially for kermit binary protocol download ("loadb" command), and
Karl O. Pince53515a2012-10-01 05:11:56 +00005077use "cu" for S-Record download ("loads" command). See
5078http://www.denx.de/wiki/view/DULG/SystemSetup#Section_4.3.
5079for help with kermit.
5080
wdenk85ec0bc2003-03-31 16:34:49 +00005081
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005082Nevertheless, if you absolutely want to use it try adding this
5083configuration to your "File transfer protocols" section:
wdenk52f52c12003-06-19 23:04:19 +00005084
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005085 Name Program Name U/D FullScr IO-Red. Multi
5086 X kermit /usr/bin/kermit -i -l %l -s Y U Y N N
5087 Y kermit /usr/bin/kermit -i -l %l -r N D Y N N
wdenk52f52c12003-06-19 23:04:19 +00005088
5089
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005090NetBSD Notes:
5091=============
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005092
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005093Starting at version 0.9.2, U-Boot supports NetBSD both as host
5094(build U-Boot) and target system (boots NetBSD/mpc8xx).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005095
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005096Building requires a cross environment; it is known to work on
5097NetBSD/i386 with the cross-powerpc-netbsd-1.3 package (you will also
5098need gmake since the Makefiles are not compatible with BSD make).
5099Note that the cross-powerpc package does not install include files;
5100attempting to build U-Boot will fail because <machine/ansi.h> is
5101missing. This file has to be installed and patched manually:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005102
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005103 # cd /usr/pkg/cross/powerpc-netbsd/include
5104 # mkdir powerpc
5105 # ln -s powerpc machine
5106 # cp /usr/src/sys/arch/powerpc/include/ansi.h powerpc/ansi.h
5107 # ${EDIT} powerpc/ansi.h ## must remove __va_list, _BSD_VA_LIST
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005108
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005109Native builds *don't* work due to incompatibilities between native
5110and U-Boot include files.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005111
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005112Booting assumes that (the first part of) the image booted is a
5113stage-2 loader which in turn loads and then invokes the kernel
5114proper. Loader sources will eventually appear in the NetBSD source
5115tree (probably in sys/arc/mpc8xx/stand/u-boot_stage2/); in the
wdenk2a8af182005-04-13 10:02:42 +00005116meantime, see ftp://ftp.denx.de/pub/u-boot/ppcboot_stage2.tar.gz
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005117
5118
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005119Implementation Internals:
5120=========================
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005121
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005122The following is not intended to be a complete description of every
5123implementation detail. However, it should help to understand the
5124inner workings of U-Boot and make it easier to port it to custom
5125hardware.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005126
5127
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005128Initial Stack, Global Data:
5129---------------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005130
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005131The implementation of U-Boot is complicated by the fact that U-Boot
5132starts running out of ROM (flash memory), usually without access to
5133system RAM (because the memory controller is not initialized yet).
5134This means that we don't have writable Data or BSS segments, and BSS
5135is not initialized as zero. To be able to get a C environment working
5136at all, we have to allocate at least a minimal stack. Implementation
5137options for this are defined and restricted by the CPU used: Some CPU
5138models provide on-chip memory (like the IMMR area on MPC8xx and
5139MPC826x processors), on others (parts of) the data cache can be
5140locked as (mis-) used as memory, etc.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005141
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01005142 Chris Hallinan posted a good summary of these issues to the
Wolfgang Denk06682362008-12-30 22:56:11 +01005143 U-Boot mailing list:
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00005144
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005145 Subject: RE: [U-Boot-Users] RE: More On Memory Bank x (nothingness)?
5146 From: "Chris Hallinan" <clh@net1plus.com>
5147 Date: Mon, 10 Feb 2003 16:43:46 -0500 (22:43 MET)
5148 ...
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00005149
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005150 Correct me if I'm wrong, folks, but the way I understand it
5151 is this: Using DCACHE as initial RAM for Stack, etc, does not
5152 require any physical RAM backing up the cache. The cleverness
5153 is that the cache is being used as a temporary supply of
5154 necessary storage before the SDRAM controller is setup. It's
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02005155 beyond the scope of this list to explain the details, but you
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005156 can see how this works by studying the cache architecture and
5157 operation in the architecture and processor-specific manuals.
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00005158
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005159 OCM is On Chip Memory, which I believe the 405GP has 4K. It
5160 is another option for the system designer to use as an
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02005161 initial stack/RAM area prior to SDRAM being available. Either
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005162 option should work for you. Using CS 4 should be fine if your
5163 board designers haven't used it for something that would
5164 cause you grief during the initial boot! It is frequently not
5165 used.
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00005166
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02005167 CONFIG_SYS_INIT_RAM_ADDR should be somewhere that won't interfere
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005168 with your processor/board/system design. The default value
5169 you will find in any recent u-boot distribution in
Stefan Roese8a316c92005-08-01 16:49:12 +02005170 walnut.h should work for you. I'd set it to a value larger
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005171 than your SDRAM module. If you have a 64MB SDRAM module, set
5172 it above 400_0000. Just make sure your board has no resources
5173 that are supposed to respond to that address! That code in
5174 start.S has been around a while and should work as is when
5175 you get the config right.
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00005176
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005177 -Chris Hallinan
5178 DS4.COM, Inc.
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00005179
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005180It is essential to remember this, since it has some impact on the C
5181code for the initialization procedures:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005182
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005183* Initialized global data (data segment) is read-only. Do not attempt
5184 to write it.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005185
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02005186* Do not use any uninitialized global data (or implicitely initialized
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005187 as zero data - BSS segment) at all - this is undefined, initiali-
5188 zation is performed later (when relocating to RAM).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005189
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005190* Stack space is very limited. Avoid big data buffers or things like
5191 that.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005192
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005193Having only the stack as writable memory limits means we cannot use
5194normal global data to share information beween the code. But it
5195turned out that the implementation of U-Boot can be greatly
5196simplified by making a global data structure (gd_t) available to all
5197functions. We could pass a pointer to this data as argument to _all_
5198functions, but this would bloat the code. Instead we use a feature of
5199the GCC compiler (Global Register Variables) to share the data: we
5200place a pointer (gd) to the global data into a register which we
5201reserve for this purpose.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005202
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005203When choosing a register for such a purpose we are restricted by the
5204relevant (E)ABI specifications for the current architecture, and by
5205GCC's implementation.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005206
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005207For PowerPC, the following registers have specific use:
5208 R1: stack pointer
Wolfgang Denke7670f62008-02-14 22:43:22 +01005209 R2: reserved for system use
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005210 R3-R4: parameter passing and return values
5211 R5-R10: parameter passing
5212 R13: small data area pointer
5213 R30: GOT pointer
5214 R31: frame pointer
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005215
Joakim Tjernlunde6bee802010-01-19 14:41:58 +01005216 (U-Boot also uses R12 as internal GOT pointer. r12
5217 is a volatile register so r12 needs to be reset when
5218 going back and forth between asm and C)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005219
Wolfgang Denke7670f62008-02-14 22:43:22 +01005220 ==> U-Boot will use R2 to hold a pointer to the global data
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005221
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005222 Note: on PPC, we could use a static initializer (since the
5223 address of the global data structure is known at compile time),
5224 but it turned out that reserving a register results in somewhat
5225 smaller code - although the code savings are not that big (on
5226 average for all boards 752 bytes for the whole U-Boot image,
5227 624 text + 127 data).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005228
Robin Getzc4db3352009-08-17 15:23:02 +00005229On Blackfin, the normal C ABI (except for P3) is followed as documented here:
Mike Frysinger4c58eb52008-02-04 19:26:54 -05005230 http://docs.blackfin.uclinux.org/doku.php?id=application_binary_interface
5231
Robin Getzc4db3352009-08-17 15:23:02 +00005232 ==> U-Boot will use P3 to hold a pointer to the global data
Mike Frysinger4c58eb52008-02-04 19:26:54 -05005233
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005234On ARM, the following registers are used:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005235
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005236 R0: function argument word/integer result
5237 R1-R3: function argument word
5238 R9: GOT pointer
5239 R10: stack limit (used only if stack checking if enabled)
5240 R11: argument (frame) pointer
5241 R12: temporary workspace
5242 R13: stack pointer
5243 R14: link register
5244 R15: program counter
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005245
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005246 ==> U-Boot will use R8 to hold a pointer to the global data
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005247
Thomas Chou0df01fd2010-05-21 11:08:03 +08005248On Nios II, the ABI is documented here:
5249 http://www.altera.com/literature/hb/nios2/n2cpu_nii51016.pdf
5250
5251 ==> U-Boot will use gp to hold a pointer to the global data
5252
5253 Note: on Nios II, we give "-G0" option to gcc and don't use gp
5254 to access small data sections, so gp is free.
5255
Macpaul Linafc1ce82011-10-19 20:41:11 +00005256On NDS32, the following registers are used:
5257
5258 R0-R1: argument/return
5259 R2-R5: argument
5260 R15: temporary register for assembler
5261 R16: trampoline register
5262 R28: frame pointer (FP)
5263 R29: global pointer (GP)
5264 R30: link register (LP)
5265 R31: stack pointer (SP)
5266 PC: program counter (PC)
5267
5268 ==> U-Boot will use R10 to hold a pointer to the global data
5269
Wolfgang Denkd87080b2006-03-31 18:32:53 +02005270NOTE: DECLARE_GLOBAL_DATA_PTR must be used with file-global scope,
5271or current versions of GCC may "optimize" the code too much.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005272
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005273Memory Management:
5274------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005275
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005276U-Boot runs in system state and uses physical addresses, i.e. the
5277MMU is not used either for address mapping nor for memory protection.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005278
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005279The available memory is mapped to fixed addresses using the memory
5280controller. In this process, a contiguous block is formed for each
5281memory type (Flash, SDRAM, SRAM), even when it consists of several
5282physical memory banks.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005283
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005284U-Boot is installed in the first 128 kB of the first Flash bank (on
5285TQM8xxL modules this is the range 0x40000000 ... 0x4001FFFF). After
5286booting and sizing and initializing DRAM, the code relocates itself
5287to the upper end of DRAM. Immediately below the U-Boot code some
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02005288memory is reserved for use by malloc() [see CONFIG_SYS_MALLOC_LEN
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005289configuration setting]. Below that, a structure with global Board
5290Info data is placed, followed by the stack (growing downward).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005291
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005292Additionally, some exception handler code is copied to the low 8 kB
5293of DRAM (0x00000000 ... 0x00001FFF).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005294
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005295So a typical memory configuration with 16 MB of DRAM could look like
5296this:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005297
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005298 0x0000 0000 Exception Vector code
5299 :
5300 0x0000 1FFF
5301 0x0000 2000 Free for Application Use
5302 :
5303 :
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005304
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005305 :
5306 :
5307 0x00FB FF20 Monitor Stack (Growing downward)
5308 0x00FB FFAC Board Info Data and permanent copy of global data
5309 0x00FC 0000 Malloc Arena
5310 :
5311 0x00FD FFFF
5312 0x00FE 0000 RAM Copy of Monitor Code
5313 ... eventually: LCD or video framebuffer
5314 ... eventually: pRAM (Protected RAM - unchanged by reset)
5315 0x00FF FFFF [End of RAM]
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005316
5317
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005318System Initialization:
5319----------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005320
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005321In the reset configuration, U-Boot starts at the reset entry point
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02005322(on most PowerPC systems at address 0x00000100). Because of the reset
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005323configuration for CS0# this is a mirror of the onboard Flash memory.
5324To be able to re-map memory U-Boot then jumps to its link address.
5325To be able to implement the initialization code in C, a (small!)
5326initial stack is set up in the internal Dual Ported RAM (in case CPUs
5327which provide such a feature like MPC8xx or MPC8260), or in a locked
5328part of the data cache. After that, U-Boot initializes the CPU core,
5329the caches and the SIU.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005330
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005331Next, all (potentially) available memory banks are mapped using a
5332preliminary mapping. For example, we put them on 512 MB boundaries
5333(multiples of 0x20000000: SDRAM on 0x00000000 and 0x20000000, Flash
5334on 0x40000000 and 0x60000000, SRAM on 0x80000000). Then UPM A is
5335programmed for SDRAM access. Using the temporary configuration, a
5336simple memory test is run that determines the size of the SDRAM
5337banks.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005338
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005339When there is more than one SDRAM bank, and the banks are of
5340different size, the largest is mapped first. For equal size, the first
5341bank (CS2#) is mapped first. The first mapping is always for address
53420x00000000, with any additional banks following immediately to create
5343contiguous memory starting from 0.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005344
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005345Then, the monitor installs itself at the upper end of the SDRAM area
5346and allocates memory for use by malloc() and for the global Board
5347Info data; also, the exception vector code is copied to the low RAM
5348pages, and the final stack is set up.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005349
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005350Only after this relocation will you have a "normal" C environment;
5351until that you are restricted in several ways, mostly because you are
5352running from ROM, and because the code will have to be relocated to a
5353new address in RAM.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005354
5355
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005356U-Boot Porting Guide:
5357----------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005358
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005359[Based on messages by Jerry Van Baren in the U-Boot-Users mailing
5360list, October 2002]
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005361
5362
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04005363int main(int argc, char *argv[])
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005364{
5365 sighandler_t no_more_time;
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005366
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04005367 signal(SIGALRM, no_more_time);
5368 alarm(PROJECT_DEADLINE - toSec (3 * WEEK));
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005369
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005370 if (available_money > available_manpower) {
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04005371 Pay consultant to port U-Boot;
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005372 return 0;
5373 }
5374
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005375 Download latest U-Boot source;
5376
Wolfgang Denk06682362008-12-30 22:56:11 +01005377 Subscribe to u-boot mailing list;
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005378
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04005379 if (clueless)
5380 email("Hi, I am new to U-Boot, how do I get started?");
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005381
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005382 while (learning) {
5383 Read the README file in the top level directory;
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04005384 Read http://www.denx.de/twiki/bin/view/DULG/Manual;
5385 Read applicable doc/*.README;
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005386 Read the source, Luke;
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04005387 /* find . -name "*.[chS]" | xargs grep -i <keyword> */
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005388 }
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005389
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04005390 if (available_money > toLocalCurrency ($2500))
5391 Buy a BDI3000;
5392 else
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005393 Add a lot of aggravation and time;
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04005394
5395 if (a similar board exists) { /* hopefully... */
5396 cp -a board/<similar> board/<myboard>
5397 cp include/configs/<similar>.h include/configs/<myboard>.h
5398 } else {
5399 Create your own board support subdirectory;
5400 Create your own board include/configs/<myboard>.h file;
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005401 }
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04005402 Edit new board/<myboard> files
5403 Edit new include/configs/<myboard>.h
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005404
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04005405 while (!accepted) {
5406 while (!running) {
5407 do {
5408 Add / modify source code;
5409 } until (compiles);
5410 Debug;
5411 if (clueless)
5412 email("Hi, I am having problems...");
5413 }
5414 Send patch file to the U-Boot email list;
5415 if (reasonable critiques)
5416 Incorporate improvements from email list code review;
5417 else
5418 Defend code as written;
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005419 }
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005420
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005421 return 0;
5422}
5423
5424void no_more_time (int sig)
5425{
5426 hire_a_guru();
5427}
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005428
5429
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005430Coding Standards:
5431-----------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005432
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005433All contributions to U-Boot should conform to the Linux kernel
Detlev Zundel2c051652006-09-01 15:39:02 +02005434coding style; see the file "Documentation/CodingStyle" and the script
Wolfgang Denk7ca92962011-07-27 10:59:55 +00005435"scripts/Lindent" in your Linux kernel source directory.
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005436
Detlev Zundel2c051652006-09-01 15:39:02 +02005437Source files originating from a different project (for example the
5438MTD subsystem) are generally exempt from these guidelines and are not
5439reformated to ease subsequent migration to newer versions of those
5440sources.
5441
5442Please note that U-Boot is implemented in C (and to some small parts in
5443Assembler); no C++ is used, so please do not use C++ style comments (//)
5444in your code.
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005445
5446Please also stick to the following formatting rules:
5447- remove any trailing white space
Wolfgang Denk7ca92962011-07-27 10:59:55 +00005448- use TAB characters for indentation and vertical alignment, not spaces
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005449- make sure NOT to use DOS '\r\n' line feeds
Wolfgang Denk7ca92962011-07-27 10:59:55 +00005450- do not add more than 2 consecutive empty lines to source files
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005451- do not add trailing empty lines to source files
5452
5453Submissions which do not conform to the standards may be returned
5454with a request to reformat the changes.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005455
5456
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005457Submitting Patches:
5458-------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005459
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005460Since the number of patches for U-Boot is growing, we need to
5461establish some rules. Submissions which do not conform to these rules
5462may be rejected, even when they contain important and valuable stuff.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005463
Magnus Lilja0d28f342008-08-06 19:32:33 +02005464Please see http://www.denx.de/wiki/U-Boot/Patches for details.
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01005465
Wolfgang Denk06682362008-12-30 22:56:11 +01005466Patches shall be sent to the u-boot mailing list <u-boot@lists.denx.de>;
5467see http://lists.denx.de/mailman/listinfo/u-boot
5468
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005469When you send a patch, please include the following information with
5470it:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005471
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005472* For bug fixes: a description of the bug and how your patch fixes
5473 this bug. Please try to include a way of demonstrating that the
5474 patch actually fixes something.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005475
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005476* For new features: a description of the feature and your
5477 implementation.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005478
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005479* A CHANGELOG entry as plaintext (separate from the patch)
5480
5481* For major contributions, your entry to the CREDITS file
5482
5483* When you add support for a new board, don't forget to add this
Wolfgang Denk7ca92962011-07-27 10:59:55 +00005484 board to the MAINTAINERS file, too.
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005485
5486* If your patch adds new configuration options, don't forget to
5487 document these in the README file.
5488
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01005489* The patch itself. If you are using git (which is *strongly*
5490 recommended) you can easily generate the patch using the
Wolfgang Denk7ca92962011-07-27 10:59:55 +00005491 "git format-patch". If you then use "git send-email" to send it to
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01005492 the U-Boot mailing list, you will avoid most of the common problems
5493 with some other mail clients.
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005494
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01005495 If you cannot use git, use "diff -purN OLD NEW". If your version of
5496 diff does not support these options, then get the latest version of
5497 GNU diff.
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005498
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01005499 The current directory when running this command shall be the parent
5500 directory of the U-Boot source tree (i. e. please make sure that
5501 your patch includes sufficient directory information for the
5502 affected files).
5503
5504 We prefer patches as plain text. MIME attachments are discouraged,
5505 and compressed attachments must not be used.
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005506
5507* If one logical set of modifications affects or creates several
5508 files, all these changes shall be submitted in a SINGLE patch file.
5509
5510* Changesets that contain different, unrelated modifications shall be
5511 submitted as SEPARATE patches, one patch per changeset.
5512
5513
5514Notes:
5515
5516* Before sending the patch, run the MAKEALL script on your patched
5517 source tree and make sure that no errors or warnings are reported
5518 for any of the boards.
5519
5520* Keep your modifications to the necessary minimum: A patch
5521 containing several unrelated changes or arbitrary reformats will be
5522 returned with a request to re-formatting / split it.
5523
5524* If you modify existing code, make sure that your new code does not
5525 add to the memory footprint of the code ;-) Small is beautiful!
5526 When adding new features, these should compile conditionally only
5527 (using #ifdef), and the resulting code with the new feature
5528 disabled must not need more memory than the old code without your
5529 modification.
wdenk90dc6702005-05-03 14:12:25 +00005530
Wolfgang Denk06682362008-12-30 22:56:11 +01005531* Remember that there is a size limit of 100 kB per message on the
5532 u-boot mailing list. Bigger patches will be moderated. If they are
5533 reasonable and not too big, they will be acknowledged. But patches
5534 bigger than the size limit should be avoided.